blob: 2a1782ad451d19d68964d62b51f77822b80b3fa2 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7d1b48f2016-05-10 15:36:58 +02007 2016/05/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200581 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200582 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200583 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - tune.buffers.limit
585 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200586 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200587 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100588 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100589 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200590 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100591 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100592 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100593 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100594 - tune.lua.session-timeout
595 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200596 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100597 - tune.maxaccept
598 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200600 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200601 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100602 - tune.rcvbuf.client
603 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100604 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100605 - tune.sndbuf.client
606 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100607 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100608 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200609 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100610 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200611 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200612 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200613 - tune.vars.global-max-size
614 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
615 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
616 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100617 - tune.zlib.memlevel
618 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100619
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 * Debugging
621 - debug
622 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626------------------------------------
627
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200628ca-base <dir>
629 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200630 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
631 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633chroot <jail dir>
634 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
635 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
636 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
637 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
638 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
639 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100641cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
642 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
643 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
644 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100645 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
646 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
647 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
648 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
649 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
650 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
651 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
652 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
653 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
654 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200656crt-base <dir>
657 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
658 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
659 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661daemon
662 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
663 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
664 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
665
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200666deviceatlas-json-file <path>
667 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
668 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
669
670deviceatlas-log-level <value>
671 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
672 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
673
674deviceatlas-separator <char>
675 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
676 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
677
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100678deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200679 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
680 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
681 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900683external-check
684 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
685 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
686 See "option external-check".
687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688gid <number>
689 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
690 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
691 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100692 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
693 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696group <group name>
697 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
698 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200700log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
702 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100703 configured with "log global".
704
705 <address> can be one of:
706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100707 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100708 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
709 port).
710
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100711 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
712 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
713 port).
714
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
716 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
717 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
718 writeable).
719
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200720 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
721 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100722
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200723 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
724 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
725 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
726 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
727 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
728 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
729 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
730 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
731 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
732 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
733 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
734
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200735 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
736 one of the following :
737
738 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
739 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
740
741 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
742 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
743
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100744 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200745
746 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
747 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
748 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
749
750 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200751 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
752 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
753 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
754 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
755 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
756 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200758 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200759
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100760log-send-hostname [<string>]
761 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
762 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
763 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
764 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
765 the logs.
766
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000767log-tag <string>
768 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
769 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
770 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100771 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000772
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100773lua-load <file>
774 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
775 used multiple times.
776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777nbproc <number>
778 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
779 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
780 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
781 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
782 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
783
784pidfile <pidfile>
785 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
786 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
787 starting the process. See also "daemon".
788
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100789presetenv <name> <value>
790 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
791 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
792 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
793 and "unsetenv".
794
795resetenv [<name> ...]
796 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
797 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
798 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
799 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
800 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
801 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
802 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
803 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
804
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100805stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200806 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
807 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
808 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
809 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
810 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
811 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200813 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
814 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200815
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200816server-state-base <directory>
817 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200818 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
819 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200820
821server-state-file <file>
822 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
823 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
824 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
825 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
826 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
827 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
828 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
829 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200830 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
831 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200832
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100833setenv <name> <value>
834 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
835 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
836 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
837 and "unsetenv".
838
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100839ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
841 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100843 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
844 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
845 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
846 "bind" keyword for more information.
847
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100848ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
850 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
851 keyword to see available options.
852
853 Example:
854 global
855 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
856
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100857ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
859 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300860 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100861 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
862 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
863 information.
864
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100865ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
867 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
868 keyword to see available options.
869
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200870ssl-dh-param-file <file>
871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
872 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
873 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
874 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
875 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200876 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
877 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
878 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
879 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
881 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
882 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
883
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100884ssl-server-verify [none|required]
885 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
886 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
887 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
888
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200889stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
890 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
891 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
892 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200893 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
894 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
897 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
898 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200899
900stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
901 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
902 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100903 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200904
905stats maxconn <connections>
906 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
907 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200909uid <number>
910 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
911 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
912 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
913 one. See also "gid" and "user".
914
915ulimit-n <number>
916 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
917 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
918 option.
919
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100920unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
921 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
922
923 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
924 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
925 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
926 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
927 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
928 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
929 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
930 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
931 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
932 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
933
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100934unsetenv [<name> ...]
935 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
936 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
937 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
938 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
939 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
940 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
941 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200943user <user name>
944 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
945 See also "uid" and "group".
946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200947node <name>
948 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
949
950 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
951 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
952 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
953 traffic.
954
955description <text>
956 Add a text that describes the instance.
957
958 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
959 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
960 "<" and ">" characters.
961
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096251degrees-data-file <file path>
963 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
964 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
965
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200966 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100967 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
968
96951degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
970 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
971 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
972 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
973
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200974 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100975 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
976
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100978 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
979 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
98451degrees-cache-size <number>
985 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
986 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
987 By default, this cache is disabled.
988
989 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100990 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994-----------------------
995
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200996max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
997 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
998 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
999 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1000 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1001 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1002 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1003 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1004 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006maxconn <number>
1007 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1008 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1009 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001010 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1011 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1012 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1013 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001014 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1015 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1016 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1017 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1018 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001020maxconnrate <number>
1021 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1022 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1023 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1024 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1025 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1026 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1027 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1028 fairness.
1029
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001030maxcomprate <number>
1031 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001032 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001033 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1034 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1035 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1036 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1037 default value.
1038
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001039maxcompcpuusage <number>
1040 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1041 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1042 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1043 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1044 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1045 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1046 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1047 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1048
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001049maxpipes <number>
1050 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1051 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1052 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1053 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1054 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1055 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1056
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057maxsessrate <number>
1058 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1059 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1060 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1061 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1062 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1063 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1064 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1065 fairness.
1066
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001067maxsslconn <number>
1068 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1069 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1070 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1071 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1072 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1073 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1074 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001075 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1076 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1077 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1078 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1079 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1080 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1081 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001082
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001083maxsslrate <number>
1084 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1085 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1086 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1087 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1088 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1089 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1090 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1091 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1092 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1093 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1094
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001095maxzlibmem <number>
1096 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1097 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1098 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001099 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1100 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1101 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103noepoll
1104 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1105 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001106 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107
1108nokqueue
1109 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1110 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1111 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1112
1113nopoll
1114 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1115 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001116 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001117 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001119nosplice
1120 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1121 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1122 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001123 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001124 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1125 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1126 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1127 "option splice-response".
1128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001129nogetaddrinfo
1130 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1131 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1132
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001133spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001134 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1135 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1136 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1137 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1138 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1139 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001140
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001141tune.buffers.limit <number>
1142 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1143 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1144 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1145 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1146 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1147 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1148 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1149 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1150 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1151 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1152 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1153 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1154 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1155 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1156 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1157
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001158tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1159 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1160 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1161 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1162 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1163
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001164tune.bufsize <number>
1165 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1166 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1167 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1168 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1169 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1170 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1171 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1172 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001173 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1174 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1175 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001176
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001177tune.chksize <number>
1178 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1179 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1180 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1181 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1182 checks whenever possible.
1183
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001184tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1185 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1186 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1187 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1188 this value. The default value is 1.
1189
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001190tune.http.cookielen <number>
1191 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1192 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1193 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1194 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1195 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1196 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1197 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1198 to change this value.
1199
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001200tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1201 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1202 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1203 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1204 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1205 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1206 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1207 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1208 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1209 limit too high.
1210
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001211tune.idletimer <timeout>
1212 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1213 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1214 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1215 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1216 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1217 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1218 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1219 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1220 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1221
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001222tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1223 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1224 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1225 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1226 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1227 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1228 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1229 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1230
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001231tune.lua.maxmem
1232 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1233 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1234 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1235 memory.
1236
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001237tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1238 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001239 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1240 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1241 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242
1243tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1244 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1245 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1246 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1247 check servers.
1248
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001249tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1250 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1251 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1252 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1253 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1254
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001255tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001256 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1257 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1258 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1259 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1260 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1261 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1262 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1263 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1264 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1265 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001266
1267tune.maxpollevents <number>
1268 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1269 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1270 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1271 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1272 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1273
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001274tune.maxrewrite <number>
1275 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1276 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1277 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1278 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1279 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1280 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1281 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1282 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1283 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1284 bufsize.
1285
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001286tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1287 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1288 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1289 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1290 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1291 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1292 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1293 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1294 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1295 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1296 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1297 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1298 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1299 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1300 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1301 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1302 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1303 setting this parameter to 0.
1304
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001305tune.pipesize <number>
1306 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1307 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1308 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1309 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1310 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1311 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1312
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001313tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1314tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1315 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1316 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1317 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1318 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1319 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1320 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1321 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1322
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001323tune.recv_enough <number>
1324 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1325 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1326 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1327 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1328 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1329
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001330tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1331tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1332 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1333 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1334 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1335 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1336 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1337 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1338 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1339 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1340 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1341 notifying haproxy again.
1342
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001343tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001344 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1345 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1346 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001347 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001348 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1349 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1350 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1351 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1352 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001353 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1354 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001355
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001356tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1357 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1358 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1359 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1360 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1361 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1362 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1363
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001364tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1365 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001366 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001367 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1368 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1369 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1370 being used for too long.
1371
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001372tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1373 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1374 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1375 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1376 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1377 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1378 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1379 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1380 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1381 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1382 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001383 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1384 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001385
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001386tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1387 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1388 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1389 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1390 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1391 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1392 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1393 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001394 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1395 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001396
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001397tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1398 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1399 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1400 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1401 1000 entries.
1402
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001403tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1404tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1405tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1406tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001407 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1408 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1409 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1410 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1411 response processing.
1412 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1413 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1414 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001415
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001416 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1417 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1418 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1419 all available space is consumed.
1420 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1421 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1422 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001423
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001424tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1425 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001426 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001427 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1428 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1429 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1430
1431tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1432 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1433 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1434 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1435 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373.3. Debugging
1438--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
1440debug
1441 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1442 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1443 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1444 system startup.
1445
1446quiet
1447 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1448 line argument "-q".
1449
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014513.4. Userlists
1452--------------
1453It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1454http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1455it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1456
1457userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001458 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001459 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1460
1461group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001462 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001463 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1464 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1465
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001466user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1467 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1469 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001470 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1471 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001472 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001473 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001474
1475
1476 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001477 userlist L1
1478 group G1 users tiger,scott
1479 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001480
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001481 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1482 user scott insecure-password elgato
1483 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001484
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001485 userlist L2
1486 group G1
1487 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001488
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001489 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1490 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1491 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001492
1493 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001494
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001495
14963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001497----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001498It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1499several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1500instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1501values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1502automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1503In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1504using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1505tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1506reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1507Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1508that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1509each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001510
1511peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001512 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001513 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1514
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001515disabled
1516 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1517 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1518 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1519
1520enable
1521 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1522
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001523peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1524 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1525 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1526 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1527 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1528 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1529 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1530
1531 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1532 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1533
1534 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1535 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1536 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1537 across all peers.
1538
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001539 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1540 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001541
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001542 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001543 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001544 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1545 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1546 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001547
1548 backend mybackend
1549 mode tcp
1550 balance roundrobin
1551 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1552 stick on src
1553
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001554 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1555 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001556
1557
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015583.6. Mailers
1559------------
1560It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1561If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1562in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1563
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001564mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001565 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1566 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1567
1568mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1569 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1570
1571 Example:
1572 mailers mymailers
1573 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1574 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1575
1576 backend mybackend
1577 mode tcp
1578 balance roundrobin
1579
1580 email-alert mailers mymailers
1581 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1582 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1583
1584 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1585 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1586
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001587timeout mail <time>
1588 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1589 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1590 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1591 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 mailers mymailers
1595 timeout mail 20s
1596 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001602 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603 - frontend <name>
1604 - backend <name>
1605 - listen <name>
1606
1607A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1608its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1609section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
1612A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1613connections.
1614
1615A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1616to forward incoming connections.
1617
1618A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1619parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1622'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1623case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1624
1625Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1626logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1627proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1628However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1629name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1630
1631Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1632and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001633bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1635modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1636arbitrary criteria.
1637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001638In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1639a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1640the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1641
1642 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1643 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1644 between responses and new requests.
1645
1646 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1647 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1648 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1649 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1650
1651 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1652 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1653 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1654
1655 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1656 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1657 client-facing connection remains open.
1658
1659 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1660 after the end of the response.
1661
1662The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1663frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1664following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1665weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1666
1667 Backend mode
1668
1669 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1670 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1671 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1672 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1673 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1674 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1675 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1676 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1677 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1678 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1679 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1684--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001686The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1687limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1688they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1689limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001690marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001692and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1693with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1694specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001696
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001697 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1698------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1699acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001700appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001701backlog X X X -
1702balance X - X X
1703bind - X X -
1704bind-process X X X X
1705block - X X X
1706capture cookie - X X -
1707capture request header - X X -
1708capture response header - X X -
1709clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001710compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001711contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1712cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001713declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714default-server X - X X
1715default_backend X X X -
1716description - X X X
1717disabled X X X X
1718dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001719email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001720email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001721email-alert mailers X X X X
1722email-alert myhostname X X X X
1723email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724enabled X X X X
1725errorfile X X X X
1726errorloc X X X X
1727errorloc302 X X X X
1728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1729errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001730force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001731filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001732fullconn X - X X
1733grace X X X X
1734hash-type X - X X
1735http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001736http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001737http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001738http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001739http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001740http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001741http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001742id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001743ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001745log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001746log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001747log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001748log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001749max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750maxconn X X X -
1751mode X X X X
1752monitor fail - X X -
1753monitor-net X X X -
1754monitor-uri X X X -
1755option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1756option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1757option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1758option allbackups (*) X - X X
1759option checkcache (*) X - X X
1760option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1761option contstats (*) X X X -
1762option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1763option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1764option forceclose (*) X X X X
1765-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1766option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001767option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001768option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001769option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001770option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001771option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001772option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001773option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001774option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1775option httpchk X - X X
1776option httpclose (*) X X X X
1777option httplog X X X X
1778option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001780option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001781option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001782option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1783option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1784option logasap (*) X X X -
1785option mysql-check X - X X
1786option nolinger (*) X X X X
1787option originalto X X X X
1788option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001789option pgsql-check X - X X
1790option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001791option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001792option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001793option smtpchk X - X X
1794option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1795option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1796option splice-request (*) X X X X
1797option splice-response (*) X X X X
1798option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1799option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1800-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001801option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001802option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1803option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1804option tcpka X X X X
1805option tcplog X X X X
1806option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001807external-check command X - X X
1808external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001809persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1810rate-limit sessions X X X -
1811redirect - X X X
1812redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1813redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1814reqadd - X X X
1815reqallow - X X X
1816reqdel - X X X
1817reqdeny - X X X
1818reqiallow - X X X
1819reqidel - X X X
1820reqideny - X X X
1821reqipass - X X X
1822reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823reqitarpit - X X X
1824reqpass - X X X
1825reqrep - X X X
1826-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827reqtarpit - X X X
1828retries X - X X
1829rspadd - X X X
1830rspdel - X X X
1831rspdeny - X X X
1832rspidel - X X X
1833rspideny - X X X
1834rspirep - X X X
1835rsprep - X X X
1836server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001837server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838source X - X X
1839srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001840stats admin - X X X
1841stats auth X X X X
1842stats enable X X X X
1843stats hide-version X X X X
1844stats http-request - X X X
1845stats realm X X X X
1846stats refresh X X X X
1847stats scope X X X X
1848stats show-desc X X X X
1849stats show-legends X X X X
1850stats show-node X X X X
1851stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001852-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1853stick match - - X X
1854stick on - - X X
1855stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001856stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001858tcp-check connect - - X X
1859tcp-check expect - - X X
1860tcp-check send - - X X
1861tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001862tcp-request connection - X X -
1863tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001864tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001865tcp-response content - - X X
1866tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001867timeout check X - X X
1868timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001869timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001870timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1871timeout connect X - X X
1872timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1873timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1874timeout http-request X X X X
1875timeout queue X - X X
1876timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001877timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001878timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1879timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001880timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001882unique-id-format X X X -
1883unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001885use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1887 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1891---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1894
1895
1896acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1897 Declare or complete an access list.
1898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1899 no | yes | yes | yes
1900 Example:
1901 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1902 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1903 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906
1907
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001908appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1909 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 no | no | yes | yes
1913 Arguments :
1914 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1915 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1916
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001917 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 checked in each cookie value.
1919
1920 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1921 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1922 milliseconds.
1923
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001924 request-learn
1925 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1926 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1927 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1928 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1929 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1930 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1931
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001932 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1933 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1934 data following this prefix.
1935
1936 Example :
1937 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1938
1939 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1940 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1941
1942 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1943 2 modes are currently supported :
1944 - path-parameters :
1945 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1946 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1947 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1948 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1949 - query-string :
1950 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1951 query string.
1952
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001953 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1954 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1955 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001957 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1958 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001961backlog <conns>
1962 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 yes | yes | yes | no
1965 Arguments :
1966 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1967 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001968 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001969
1970 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1971 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1972 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1973 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1974 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1975 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1976 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1977 backlog parameter.
1978
1979 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1980 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1981 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1982
1983 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1984
1985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001987balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1990 yes | no | yes | yes
1991 Arguments :
1992 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1993 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1994 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1995 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1996
1997 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1998 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1999 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2000 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002001 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002002 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002003 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2004 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2005 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2006 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2007 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2008 it, so that you don't worry.
2009
2010 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2011 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2012 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2013 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2014 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2015 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2016 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2017 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002018
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002019 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2020 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2021 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2022 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2023 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2024 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2025 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2026 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2027
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002028 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002029 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002030 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2031 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002032 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2034 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2035 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2036 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2037 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002038 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2039 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2040 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2041 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2042 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2043 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2046 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2047 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2048 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2049 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2050 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2051 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2052 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002053 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002055 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2056 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2057 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002059 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2060 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2061 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2062 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2063 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2064 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2065 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2066 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2067 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2068 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2069 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2070 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002072 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002073 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2074 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2075 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2076 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2077 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2078 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2079 URIs start with a leading "/".
2080
2081 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2082 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2083 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2084 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002087 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2088
2089 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002090 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2091 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002092 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2093 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2094 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2095 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002097 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2098 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002099
2100 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2101 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2102 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2103 server will receive the request.
2104
2105 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2106 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2107 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2108 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2109 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002110 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2111 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2112 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002114 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2115 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2116 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2117 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2118 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002120 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002121 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2122 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2123 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2124
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002125 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2126 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2127 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2128
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002129 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002130 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002131 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2132 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2133 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2134 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2135 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2136 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002137 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002138 used instead.
2139
2140 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2141 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2142 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2143 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2144
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002145 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2146 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2147 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2148
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002149 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002152 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2153 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002154
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002155 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2156 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2157 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
2159 Examples :
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002162 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002163 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2164 balance hdr(host)
2165 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002166
2167 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2168 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002170 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002171 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2172 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2173 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2174 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2175
2176 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2177 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2178 defaults to 16 kB.
2179
2180 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2181 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2182
2183 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2184 Round Robin.
2185
2186 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2187 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2188 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2189 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2190
2191 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2192
2193 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002194 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002195 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2196 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2197 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002199 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200
2201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002202bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2203bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | yes | yes | no
2207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002208 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2209 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2210 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2211 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002212 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002213 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2214 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2215 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2216 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2217 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2218 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2219 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002220 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2221 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2222 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2223 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2224 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2225 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2226 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002227 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2228 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2229 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002230 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2231 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2232 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002233
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002234 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2235 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002236 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2237 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2238 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002239 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2240 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2241 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2242 the range.
2243
2244 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2245 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2246 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2247 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2248 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2249 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2250 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002251 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002252 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002254 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2255 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2256 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2257 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2258 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2259 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2260 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2261 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2262
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002263 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2264 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2265 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2266 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2269 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2270 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2271 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2272 in a frontend.
2273
2274 Example :
2275 listen http_proxy
2276 bind :80,:443
2277 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002278 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002280 listen http_https_proxy
2281 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002282 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002283
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002284 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2285 bind ipv6@:80
2286 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2287 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2288
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002289 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002290 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002291
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002292 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2293 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2294 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2295 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2296 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2297
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002298 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002299 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
2301
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002302bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002303 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2305 yes | yes | yes | yes
2306 Arguments :
2307 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2308 may be used to override a default value.
2309
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002310 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002311 option may be combined with other numbers.
2312
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002313 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002314 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2315 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2316 missing from all processes.
2317
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002318 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002319 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002320 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2321 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2322 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2323 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002324
2325 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2326 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2327 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2328 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2329 and 'even' instances.
2330
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002331 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2332 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2333 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2334 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002335
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002336 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2337 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2338
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002339 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2340 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2341 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2342
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002343 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2344 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2345
2346 Example :
2347 listen app_ip1
2348 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002349 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002350
2351 listen app_ip2
2352 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002353 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002354
2355 listen management
2356 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002357 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002358
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002359 listen management
2360 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2361 bind-process 1-4
2362
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002363 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002364
2365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366block { if | unless } <condition>
2367 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370
2371 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2372 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002373 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002374 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2376 "block" statements per instance.
2377
2378 Example:
2379 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2380 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2381 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2382 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002384 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
2386
2387capture cookie <name> len <length>
2388 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2390 no | yes | yes | no
2391 Arguments :
2392 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2393 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2394 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2395 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2396 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2397
2398 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2399 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2400 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2401 right if it exceeds <length>.
2402
2403 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2404 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2405 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2406 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2407
2408 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2409 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2410 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2411
2412 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2413 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2414 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002415 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2416 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2417 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
2419 Example:
2420 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2421
2422 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002423 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425
2426capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002427 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | no
2430 Arguments :
2431 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002432 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2434 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2435 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2436
2437 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2438 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2439 it exceeds <length>.
2440
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002441 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2443 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002444 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2445 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2446 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2447 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002448 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002449 environments to find where the request came from.
2450
2451 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2452 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2453 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2454 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002456 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2457 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2458 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2459 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2460 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 Example:
2463 capture request header Host len 15
2464 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002465 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002467 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 about logging.
2469
2470
2471capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002472 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2474 no | yes | yes | no
2475 Arguments :
2476 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002477 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2479 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2480 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2481
2482 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2483 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2484 it exceeds <length>.
2485
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002486 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002487 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2488 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2489 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002490 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2491 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2492 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2493 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002495 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2496 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2497 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2498 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2499 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500
2501 Example:
2502 capture response header Content-length len 9
2503 capture response header Location len 15
2504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002505 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 about logging.
2507
2508
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002509clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | no
2513 Arguments :
2514 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2516 as explained at the top of this document.
2517
2518 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2519 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2520 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2521 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2522 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2523 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2524 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2525 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002526 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2528 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2529
2530 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2532 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2533 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2534 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2535 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2536
2537 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2538 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2539
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002540 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2541 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002543compression algo <algorithm> ...
2544compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002545compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002546 Enable HTTP compression.
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002550 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2551 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2552 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2553
2554 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002555 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2556 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2557 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002559 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002560 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002561
2562 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2563 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2564 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2565 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2566 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002567 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002568
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002569 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2570 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2571 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2572 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2573 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2574 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2575 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002576 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002577
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002578 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002579 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002580 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2581 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2582 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2583 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2584 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002585
2586 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2587 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2588 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2589 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2590 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002591 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2592 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2593 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2594 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2595 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002596 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2597 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002598
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002599 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002600 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2601 "Accept-Encoding" header
2602 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002603 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002604 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2605 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2607 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2608 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2609 "multipart"
2610 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2611 header
2612 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2613 and later
2614 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2615 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002616
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002617 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2618 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002619
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002620 Examples :
2621 compression algo gzip
2622 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002624
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002625contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 yes | no | yes | yes
2629 Arguments :
2630 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2631 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2632 as explained at the top of this document.
2633
2634 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002635 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002636 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2638 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2639 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2640 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2641
2642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2644 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2645 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2646 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2647 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2648
2649 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2650 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2651 instead.
2652
2653 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2654 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2655
2656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002657cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002658 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2659 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | no | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
2664 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2665 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2666 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2667 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2668 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2669 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2670 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2671 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2672 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2673
2674 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2675 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2676 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2677 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2678 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2679 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002680 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2681 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2682 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2683 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2684 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
2686 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002687 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002688
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002689 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002690 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2691 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2692 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2693 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2694 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2695 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2696 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2697 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2698 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2699 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
2701 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2702 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2703 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2704 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2705 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2706 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2707 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2708 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2709 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002710 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002711 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2712 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2713 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002715 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2716 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2717 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002718 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2719 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2720 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2721 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002722 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2723 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2724 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
2726 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2727 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2728 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2729 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2730 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2731 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2732 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2733 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2734 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2735
2736 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2737 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2738 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2739 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2740 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2741 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2742 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2743 persistence cookie in the cache.
2744 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2745
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002746 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2747 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2748 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2749 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2750 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2751 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2752 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2753 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2754 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2755 they logout.
2756
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002757 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2758 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2759 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2760 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2761
2762 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2763 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2764 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2765 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2766 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2767 this attribute.
2768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002769 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002770 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002771 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2772 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2773 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2774 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2775 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2776 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002777
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002778 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2779 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2780 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2781 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2782 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2783 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2784 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2785 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2786 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2787 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2788 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2789 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2790 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2791 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2792 the site.
2793
2794 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2795 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2796 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2797 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2798 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2799 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2800 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2801 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2802 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2803 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2804 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2805 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2806 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2807 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2808 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2809 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2812 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2813 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2814 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 Examples :
2817 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2818 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2819 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002820 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002822 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002824
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002825declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2826 Declares a capture slot.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 no | yes | yes | no
2829 Arguments:
2830 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2831
2832 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2833 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2834 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2835 for use in the response.
2836
2837 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002838 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002839 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2840
2841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002842default-server [param*]
2843 Change default options for a server in a backend
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | no | yes | yes
2846 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002847 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2848 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2849 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2850 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002851
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002852 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002853 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2854
2855 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858default_backend <backend>
2859 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 yes | yes | yes | no
2862 Arguments :
2863 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2864
2865 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2866 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2867 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2868 will catch all undetermined requests.
2869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 Example :
2871
2872 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2873 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2874 default_backend dynamic
2875
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002876 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002879description <string>
2880 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 no | yes | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : string
2884
2885 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2886 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2887 it describes.
2888 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2889
2890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891disabled
2892 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | yes | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2898 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2899 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2900 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2901 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2902 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2903 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2904
2905 See also : "enabled"
2906
2907
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002908dispatch <address>:<port>
2909 Set a default server address
2910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2911 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002913
2914 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2915 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2916 during start-up.
2917
2918 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2919 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2920 possible with normal servers.
2921
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002922 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002923 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2924 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2925 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2926 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2927
2928 See also : "server"
2929
2930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931enabled
2932 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments : none
2936
2937 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2938 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2939
2940 See also : "disabled"
2941
2942
2943errorfile <code> <file>
2944 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | yes
2947 Arguments :
2948 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002949 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2950 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002953 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002955 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2956 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
2958 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2959 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2960 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2961
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002962 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2965 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2966 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2967 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2968
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002969 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2970 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2971 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2972 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2973 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2974 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2977 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2978 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002979 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2981
2982 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2983
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002984 Example :
2985 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002986 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002987 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2988 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002990
2991errorloc <code> <url>
2992errorloc302 <code> <url>
2993 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments :
2997 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002998 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002999
3000 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3001 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3002 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3003 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3004 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3005
3006 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3007 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3008 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3009
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003010 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003012 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3013 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3014 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3015 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003016 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003017 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3018 request.
3019
3020 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3021
3022
3023errorloc303 <code> <url>
3024 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | yes | yes | yes
3027 Arguments :
3028 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3029 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3030
3031 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3032 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3033 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3034 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3035 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3036
3037 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3038 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3039 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3040
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003041 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3042
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003043 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3044 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3045 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3046 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003047 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048
3049 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3050
3051
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003052email-alert from <emailaddr>
3053 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3054 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 Arguments :
3059
3060 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3061
3062 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3063 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3064
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003065 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003066 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3067 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003068
3069
3070email-alert level <level>
3071 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3072 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | yes | yes | yes
3075
3076 Arguments :
3077
3078 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3079 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3080 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3081
3082 By default level is alert
3083
3084 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3085 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3086 for the proxy.
3087
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003088 Alerts are sent when :
3089
3090 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3091 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3092 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3093 is notice or lower
3094 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3095 and a health check status update occurs
3096
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003097 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3098 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003099 section 3.6 about mailers.
3100
3101
3102email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3103 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | yes | yes | yes
3106
3107 Arguments :
3108
3109 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3110
3111 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3112 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3113
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003114 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3115 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003116
3117
3118email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3119 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3120 mailers.
3121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 yes | yes | yes | yes
3123
3124 Arguments :
3125
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003126 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003127
3128 By default the systems hostname is used.
3129
3130 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3131 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3132 for the proxy.
3133
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003134 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3135 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003136
3137
3138email-alert to <emailaddr>
3139 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3140 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143
3144 Arguments :
3145
3146 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3147
3148 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3149 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3150
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003151 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003152 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3153
3154
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003155force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3156 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 no | yes | yes | yes
3159
3160 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3161 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3162 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3163 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3164 marked down for maintenance operations.
3165
3166 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3167 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3168 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3169 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3170 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3171 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3172 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3173 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3174 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3175
3176 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3177 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3178 is used.
3179
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003180 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003181 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003182
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003183
3184filter <name> [param*]
3185 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 no | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
3189 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3190 referenced in section 9.
3191
3192 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3193 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3194 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3195 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3196
3197 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3198 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3199
3200 Example:
3201 listen
3202 bind *:80
3203
3204 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3205 filter compression
3206 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3207
3208 compression algo gzip
3209 compression offload
3210
3211 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3212
3213 See also : section 9.
3214
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216fullconn <conns>
3217 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | no | yes | yes
3220 Arguments :
3221 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3222 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3223
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003224 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003225 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003226 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003227 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3228 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3229 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3230 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3231 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003232 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003234 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3235 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003236 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3237 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3238 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003240 Example :
3241 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3242 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3243 # connections.
3244 backend dynamic
3245 fullconn 10000
3246 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3247 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3248
3249 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3250
3251
3252grace <time>
3253 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003256 Arguments :
3257 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3258 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3259 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3260
3261 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3262 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003263 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3265
3266 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3267 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3268 simplify it.
3269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003271hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003272 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 yes | no | yes | yes
3275 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003276 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3277 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003278
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003279 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3280 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3281 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3282 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3283 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3284 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3285 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3286 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3287 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3288 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003289
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003290 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3291 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3292 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3293 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3294 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3295 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3296 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3297 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3298 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3299 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3300 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3301 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3302 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003303 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3304 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003305
3306 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003308 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003309 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3310 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3311 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003312 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3313 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3314 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003315
3316 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3317 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003318 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3319 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3320 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3321 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3322
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003323 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3324 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3325 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3326 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3327 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3328 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3329 parameter.
3330
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003331 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3332 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3333 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3334 used on strings.
3335
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003336 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3337
3338 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3339 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3340 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3341 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3342 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3343 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3344 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3345 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3346 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3347 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3348 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3349 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003350
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003351 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3352 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3353 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003354
3355 See also : "balance", "server"
3356
3357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358http-check disable-on-404
3359 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 Arguments : none
3363
3364 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3365 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3366 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3367 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3368 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3369 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3370 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3371 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003372 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3373 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3374 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3375
3376 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3377
3378
3379http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003380 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003383 Arguments :
3384 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3385 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003386 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003387 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3388 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3389 details on the supported keywords.
3390
3391 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3392 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3393 with the usual backslash ('\').
3394
3395 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3396 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3397 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3398 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3399 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3400
3401 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003402 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003403 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3404 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3405 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3406
3407 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003409 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3410 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3411 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3412 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3413
3414 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003415 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003416 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3417 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3418 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3419 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3420 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3421 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3422 trace).
3423
3424 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003426 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3427 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3428 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3429 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3430 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3431 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3432
3433 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3434 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3435 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3436 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3437 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3438 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3439 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3440 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3441
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003442 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3443 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3444 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003446 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3447 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3448
3449 Examples :
3450 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003451 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003452
3453 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003454 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003455
3456 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003457 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003458
3459 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003460 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003462 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463
3464
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003465http-check send-state
3466 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : none
3470
3471 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3472 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3473 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3474 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3475 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3476
3477 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3478 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3479 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3480 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3481 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003482 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3483 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3484 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3485
3486 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3487 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3488 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3489
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003490 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3491 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3492 checked in multiple backends.
3493
3494 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3495 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3496
3497 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3498 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3499 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3500 one fails.
3501
3502 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3503 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3504 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3505
3506 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3507 server's queue.
3508
3509 Example of a header received by the application server :
3510 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3511 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3512
3513 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3514
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003515http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3516 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003517 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003518 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003519 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003520 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3521 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003522 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3523 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003524 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3525 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3526 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003527 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003528 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003529 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003530 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003531 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003532 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003533 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003534 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003535 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3536
3537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3538 no | yes | yes | yes
3539
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003540 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3541 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3542 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3543 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3544 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003545
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003546 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3547 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3548 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3549
3550 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003551 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3552 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3553 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3554 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003555
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003556 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3557 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3558 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3559 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3560 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3561 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3562 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3563 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3564 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003565 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003566 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3567 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003568
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003569 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3570 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3571 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3572 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3573 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3574
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003575 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3576 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3577 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003578 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3579 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003580
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003581 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3582 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3583 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3584 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3585 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3586 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3587 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3588 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3589
3590 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3591 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3592 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003593 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3594 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003595
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003596 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3597 <name>.
3598
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003599 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3600 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3601 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3602 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3603 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3604 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3605 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3606 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3607
3608 Example:
3609
3610 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3611
3612 applied to:
3613
3614 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3615
3616 outputs:
3617
3618 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3619
3620 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3621
3622 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3623 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3624 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3625 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3626 header.
3627
3628 Example:
3629
3630 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3631
3632 applied to:
3633
3634 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3635
3636 outputs:
3637
3638 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3639
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003640 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3641 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3642 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3643 it.
3644
3645 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3646 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3647 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3648 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3649 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3650 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3651
3652 Example :
3653 # prepend the host name before the path
3654 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3655
3656 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3657 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3658 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3659 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3660 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3661 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3662 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3663 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3664
3665 Example :
3666 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3667 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3668
3669 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3670 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3671 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3672 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3673 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3674 "set-query".
3675
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003676 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3677 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3678 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3679 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3680 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3681 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3682 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3683 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3684
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003685 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3686 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3687 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3688 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3689 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3690 another equipment.
3691
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003692 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3693 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3694 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3695 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3696 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3697 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3698 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3699 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3700
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003701 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3702 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3703 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3704 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3705 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3706 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3707 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3708 admin privileges.
3709
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003710 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3711 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3712 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3713 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3714 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3715 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3716 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3717 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3718
3719 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3720 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3721 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3722 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3723 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3724 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3725
3726 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3727 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3728 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3729 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3730 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3731 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3732
3733 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3734 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3735 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3736 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3737 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3738 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3739 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3740 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3741 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3742
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003743 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003744 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3745 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3746 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3747 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3748 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3749 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3750 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3751 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3752 request header" for more information.
3753
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003754 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3755 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3756 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3757 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003758 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3759 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003760
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003761 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3762 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3763 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3764 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3765 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3766 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3767 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3768 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3769 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3770 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3771 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3772 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3773
3774 These actions take one or two arguments :
3775 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3776 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3777 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3778 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3779
3780 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3781 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3782 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3783 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3784
3785 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3786 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3787 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3788 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3789 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3790 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3791 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3792 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3793
3794 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3795 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3796 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3797 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3798 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3799
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003800 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3801 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3802 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3803 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3804 continues.
3805
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003806 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3807 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3808 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3809 the actions evaluation continues.
3810
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003811 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3812 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3813 inline.
3814
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003815 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3816 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3817 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3818 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003819 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003820 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003821 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003822 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3823 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003825 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003826 and '_'.
3827
3828 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3829 followed by some converters.
3830
3831 Example:
3832
3833 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3834
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003835 - set-src <expr> :
3836 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3837 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3838 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3839 source IP for privacy.
3840
3841 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3842 followed by some converters.
3843
3844 Example:
3845
3846 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3847 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3848
3849 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3850
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003851 - set-src-port <expr> :
3852 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3853 expression.
3854
3855 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3856 followed by some converters.
3857
3858 Example:
3859
3860 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3861 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3862
3863 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
3864 the source port to 0.
3865
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003866 - set-dst <expr> :
3867 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3868 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3869 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3870 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3871 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3872
3873 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3874 followed by some converters.
3875
3876 Example:
3877
3878 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
3879 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
3880
3881 - set-dst-port <expr> :
3882 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
3883 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3884 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3885
3886 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3887 followed by some converters.
3888
3889 Example:
3890
3891 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
3892 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
3893
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003894 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3895 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3896 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3897 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3898 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3899 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3900 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3901 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3902 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3903 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3904 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3905 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3906 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3907 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3908 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3909 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3910
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003911 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3912
3913 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3914 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003915 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3916 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3917
3918 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3919 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3920 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3921 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003922
3923 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003924 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3925 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3926 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003927
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003928 http-request allow if nagios
3929 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3930 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3931 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003932
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003933 Example:
3934 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003935 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003936
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003937 Example:
3938 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3939 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003940 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003941 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3942 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3943 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3944 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3945 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3946 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3947
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003948 Example:
3949 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3950 acl add path /addacl
3951 acl del path /delacl
3952
3953 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3954
3955 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3956 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3957
3958 Example:
3959 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3960 acl setmap path /setmap
3961 acl delmap path /delmap
3962
3963 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3964
3965 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3966 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3967
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003968 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3969 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003970
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003971http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003972 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003973 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003974 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3975 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003976 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003977 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3978 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3979 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3980 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003981 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003982 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08003983 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003984 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003985 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003986 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003987 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003988 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003989 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3990
3991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3992 no | yes | yes | yes
3993
3994 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3995 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3996 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3997 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3998 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3999 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4000
4001 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4002 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4003 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4004 current section.
4005
4006 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4007 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4008 rules are evaluated.
4009
4010 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4011 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4012 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4013 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4014 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4015 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4016 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4017
4018 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4019 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4020 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4021 external users.
4022
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004023 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4024 <name>.
4025
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004026 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4027 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4028 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4029 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4030 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4031 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4032 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4033 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4034
4035 Example:
4036
4037 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4038
4039 applied to:
4040
4041 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4042
4043 outputs:
4044
4045 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4046
4047 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4048
4049 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4050 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4051 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4052 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4053 header.
4054
4055 Example:
4056
4057 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4058
4059 applied to:
4060
4061 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4062
4063 outputs:
4064
4065 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4066
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004067 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4068 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4069 adapted to the new code.
4070
4071 Example:
4072
4073 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4074 http-response set-status 431
4075
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004076 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4077 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4078 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4079 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4080 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4081 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4082 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4083 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4084
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004085 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4086 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4087 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4088 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4089 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4090 another equipment.
4091
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004092 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4093 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4094 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4095 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4096 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4097 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4098 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4099 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4100
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004101 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4102 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4103 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4104 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4105 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4106 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4107 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4108 admin privileges.
4109
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004110 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4111 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4112 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4113 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4114 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4115 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4116 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4117 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4118
4119 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4120 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4121 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4122 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4123 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4124 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4125
4126 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4127 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4128 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4129 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4130 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4131 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4132
4133 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4134 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4135 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4136 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4137 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4138 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4139 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4140 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4141 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4142
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004143 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4144 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4145 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4146 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4147 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4148 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4149 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4150 response header" for more information.
4151
4152 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4153 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4154 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4155 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4156 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004157 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4158 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004159
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004160 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4161 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4162 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4163 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4164 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4165 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4166
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004167 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4168 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4169 inline.
4170
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004171 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4172 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4173 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4174 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004175 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004176 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004177 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004178 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4179 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004180 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004181 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004182 and '_'.
4183
4184 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4185 followed by some converters.
4186
4187 Example:
4188
4189 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4190
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004191 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4192 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4193 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4194 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4195 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4196 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4197 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4198
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004199 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4200 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4201 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4202 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4203 continues.
4204
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004205 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4206 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4207 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4208 the actions evaluation continues.
4209
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004210 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4211 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4212 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4213 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4214 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4215 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4216 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4217 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4218 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4219 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4220 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4221 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4222 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4223 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4224 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4225 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4226
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004227 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4228
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004229 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004230 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4231 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004232 rules.
4233
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004234 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4235 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4236 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4237 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4238
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004239 Example:
4240 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4241
4242 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4243
4244 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4245 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4246
4247 Example:
4248 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4249
4250 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4251
4252 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4253 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4254
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004255 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4256 ACL usage.
4257
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004258
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004259http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4260 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4261
4262 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4263 yes | no | yes | yes
4264
4265 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4266 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4267 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4268 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4269 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4270 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4271
4272 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4273
4274 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4275 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4276 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4277 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4278 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4279 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4280 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4281 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4282 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4283 not checking any request past the first one.
4284
4285 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4286 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4287 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4288 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4289 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4290 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4291 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4292
4293 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4294 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4295 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4296 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4297 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4298 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4299 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4300 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4301 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4302 downsides of rare connection failures.
4303
4304 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4305 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4306 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4307 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4308 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4309 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4310 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4311 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4312 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4313 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4314 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4315 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4316
4317 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4318 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4319 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4320 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4321
4322 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4323 and are never shared ;
4324
4325 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4326 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4327 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4328 and are never shared ;
4329
4330 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4331 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4332 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4333
4334 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4335 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4336 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4337
4338 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4339
4340
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004341http-send-name-header [<header>]
4342 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4343
4344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4345 yes | no | yes | yes
4346
4347 Arguments :
4348
4349 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4350
4351 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4352 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4353 is added with the header string proved.
4354
4355 See also : "server"
4356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004357id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004358 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4360 no | yes | yes | yes
4361 Arguments : none
4362
4363 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4364 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4365 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004366
4367
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004368ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4369 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4370 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4371 no | yes | yes | yes
4372
4373 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4374 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4375 and running).
4376
4377 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4378 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4379 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004380 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004381 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4382
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004383 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4384 "unless" condition is met.
4385
4386 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4387
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004388load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4389 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4390 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4391 yes | no | yes | yes
4392
4393 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4394 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4395 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4396 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4397 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4398 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4399 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4400 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4401
4402 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4403 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004404 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004405
4406 Arguments:
4407 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4408 named "server-state-file".
4409
4410 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4411 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4412 name is used as a file name.
4413
4414 none don't load any stat for this backend
4415
4416 Notes:
4417 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4418 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4419 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4420
4421 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4422 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4423
4424 Example 1:
4425
4426 Minimal configuration:
4427
4428 global
4429 stats socket /tmp/socket
4430 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4431
4432 defaults
4433 load-server-state-from-file global
4434
4435 backend bk
4436 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4437 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4438
4439 Then one can run :
4440
4441 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4442
4443 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4444
4445 1
4446 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4447 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4448 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4449
4450 Example 2:
4451
4452 Minimal configuration:
4453
4454 global
4455 stats socket /tmp/socket
4456 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4457
4458 defaults
4459 load-server-state-from-file local
4460
4461 backend bk
4462 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4463 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4464
4465 Then one can run :
4466
4467 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4468
4469 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4470
4471 1
4472 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4473 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4474 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4475
4476 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4477 "show servers state"
4478
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004479
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004480log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004481log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004482no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004483 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4485 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004486
4487 Prefix :
4488 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4489 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4490 prefix does not allow arguments.
4491
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004492 Arguments :
4493 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4494 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4495 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4496 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4497 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4498 parameter.
4499
4500 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4501 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4502
4503 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4504 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4505 standard syslog port).
4506
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004507 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4508 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4509 standard syslog port).
4510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004511 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4512 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4513 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4514 appropriately writeable).
4515
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004516 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4517 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004518
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004519 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4520 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4521 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4522 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4523 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4524 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4525 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4526 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4527 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4528 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4529 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004531 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4532
4533 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4534 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4535 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4536
4537 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4538 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4539 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004540 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4541 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4542 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4543 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4544 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004545
4546 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4547
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004548 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4549 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4550 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004551
4552 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4553 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4554 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4555 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4556
4557 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4558 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004559
4560 Example :
4561 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004562 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4563 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004564 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004566
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004567log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004568 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4570 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004571
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004572 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4573 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4574 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4575 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4576 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004577
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004578log-format-sd <string>
4579 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | yes | yes | no
4582
4583 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4584 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4585 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4586 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4587 which covers the log format string in depth.
4588
4589 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4590 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4591
4592 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4593 log format to "rfc5424".
4594
4595 Example :
4596 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4597
4598
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004599log-tag <string>
4600 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4602 yes | yes | yes | yes
4603
4604 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4605 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4606 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4607 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4608 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4609 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4610 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4611 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4612 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004613
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004614max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4615 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4616 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4617 yes | no | yes | yes
4618
4619 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4620 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4621 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4622 servers.
4623
4624 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4625 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4626 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4627 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4628 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4629 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4630 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4631 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4632 picking a different server.
4633
4634 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4635 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4636 even if they have to be queued.
4637
4638 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4639 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4640
4641
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004642maxconn <conns>
4643 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4645 yes | yes | yes | no
4646 Arguments :
4647 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4648 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4649 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4650 closes.
4651
4652 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4653 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4654 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4655 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004656 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4657 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4658 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4659 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004660
4661 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4662 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4663 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4664
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004665 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4666
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004667 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4668
4669
4670mode { tcp|http|health }
4671 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4673 yes | yes | yes | yes
4674 Arguments :
4675 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4676 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4677 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4678 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4679
4680 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4681 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4682 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4683 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4684 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4685
4686 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004687 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4688 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4689 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4690 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4691 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4692 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4693 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004694
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004695 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4696 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4697 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004698
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004699 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004700 defaults http_instances
4701 mode http
4702
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004703 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004705
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004706monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004707 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004710 Arguments :
4711 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4712 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004713 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4715 backend and its backup.
4716
4717 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4718 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4719 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4720 servers in a list of backends.
4721
4722 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4723 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4724 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4725 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4726 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4727 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4728 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004729 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4730 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731
4732 Example:
4733 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004734 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004735 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4736 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4737 monitor-uri /site_alive
4738 monitor fail if site_dead
4739
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004740 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004741
4742
4743monitor-net <source>
4744 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 yes | yes | yes | no
4747 Arguments :
4748 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4749 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4750 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4751 followed by a mask.
4752
4753 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4754 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004755 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004756 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4757
4758 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4759 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4760 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4761 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004762 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4763 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4764 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004765
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004766 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4767 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4768 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4769 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4770 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4771 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004772
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004773 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4774 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004775
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004776 Example :
4777 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4778 frontend www
4779 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4780
4781 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4782
4783
4784monitor-uri <uri>
4785 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | yes | yes | no
4788 Arguments :
4789 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4790 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4791
4792 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4793 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4794 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4795 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4796 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4797 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4798 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4799 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4800
4801 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4802 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4803 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4804 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4805 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4806 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4807
4808 Example :
4809 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4810 frontend www
4811 mode http
4812 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4813
4814 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004816
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004817option abortonclose
4818no option abortonclose
4819 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4821 yes | no | yes | yes
4822 Arguments : none
4823
4824 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4825 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4826 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4827 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004828 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004829 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4830 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4831 encountered while delivering the response.
4832
4833 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4834 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4835 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4836 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4837 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4838 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004839 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004840 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004841 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004842 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4843 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4844 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4845
4846 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4847 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4848 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4849 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4850 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4851 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4852 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4853 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004854 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004855
4856 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4857 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4858
4859 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4860
4861
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004862option accept-invalid-http-request
4863no option accept-invalid-http-request
4864 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | yes | yes | no
4867 Arguments : none
4868
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004869 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004870 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4871 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4872 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4873 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4874 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4875 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4876 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004877 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4878 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4879 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4880 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4881 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004882 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004883 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4884 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4885 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004886
4887 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4888 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4889 been confirmed.
4890
4891 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4892 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004893 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4894 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004895 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4896
4897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4899
4900 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4901 stats socket.
4902
4903
4904option accept-invalid-http-response
4905no option accept-invalid-http-response
4906 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | no | yes | yes
4909 Arguments : none
4910
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004911 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004912 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4913 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4914 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4915 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4916 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4917 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4918 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004919 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4920 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4921 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004922
4923 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4924 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4925 been confirmed.
4926
4927 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4928 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4929 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4930 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4931
4932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4934
4935 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4936 stats socket.
4937
4938
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004939option allbackups
4940no option allbackups
4941 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4943 yes | no | yes | yes
4944 Arguments : none
4945
4946 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4947 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4948 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4949 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4950 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4951 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4952 order between the backup servers anymore.
4953
4954 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4955 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4956
4957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4959
4960
4961option checkcache
4962no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004963 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | no | yes | yes
4966 Arguments : none
4967
4968 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4969 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004970 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004971 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4972 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004973 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004974
4975 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004976 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004977 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004978 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4979 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004980 to the client are :
4981 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004982 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004983 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004984 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4985 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4986 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4987 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4988 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4989 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4990 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4991 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4992 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4993 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4994 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4995
4996 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004997 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004998 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004999 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005000 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5001
5002 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5003 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005004 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005005 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5006
5007 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5008 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5009
5010
5011option clitcpka
5012no option clitcpka
5013 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5015 yes | yes | yes | no
5016 Arguments : none
5017
5018 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5019 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5020 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5021 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5022
5023 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5024 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5025 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5026 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5027
5028 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5029 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5030 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5031 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5032 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5033
5034 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5035
5036 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5037 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5038 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5039
5040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5042
5043 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5044
5045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005046option contstats
5047 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 yes | yes | yes | no
5050 Arguments : none
5051
5052 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5053 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5054 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5055 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5056 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5057 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5058 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5059
5060
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005061option dontlog-normal
5062no option dontlog-normal
5063 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5065 yes | yes | yes | no
5066 Arguments : none
5067
5068 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5069 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5070 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5071 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5072 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5073 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5074 logged.
5075
5076 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5077 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5078 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005080 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005081 logging.
5082
5083
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005084option dontlognull
5085no option dontlognull
5086 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5088 yes | yes | yes | no
5089 Arguments : none
5090
5091 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5092 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5093 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5094 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5095 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5096 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005097 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5098 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5099 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005100
5101 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5102 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5103 would not be logged.
5104
5105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5107
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005108 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5109 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005110
5111
5112option forceclose
5113no option forceclose
5114 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005117 Arguments : none
5118
5119 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5120 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5121 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5122 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5123 global session times in the logs.
5124
5125 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005126 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005127 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005128
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005129 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5130 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5131 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5132
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005133 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5134 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005135
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005136 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5137 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5138
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005139 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005140
5141
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005142option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005143 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5145 yes | yes | yes | yes
5146 Arguments :
5147 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5148 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005149 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005150 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005151
5152 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5153 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5154 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5155 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5156 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5157 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5158 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005159 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5160 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5161 possible that the client has already brought one.
5162
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005163 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005164 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005165 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5166 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005167 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5168 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005169
5170 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5171 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5172 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5173 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5174 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5175 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5176 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5177
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005178 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5179 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5180 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5181 are under the control of the end-user.
5182
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005183 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005184 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5185 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005186 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5187 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5188 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005189
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005190 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005191 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5192 frontend www
5193 mode http
5194 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5195
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005196 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5197 backend www
5198 mode http
5199 option forwardfor header X-Client
5200
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005201 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005202 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005203
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005204
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005205option http-buffer-request
5206no option http-buffer-request
5207 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5209 yes | yes | yes | yes
5210 Arguments : none
5211
5212 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5213 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5214 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5215 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5216 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5217 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5218 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5219 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5220 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5221 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5222 default.
5223
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005224 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005225
5226
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005227option http-ignore-probes
5228no option http-ignore-probes
5229 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5231 yes | yes | yes | no
5232 Arguments : none
5233
5234 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5235 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5236 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5237 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5238 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5239 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5240 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5241 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5242 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5243 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5244 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5245 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5246
5247 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5248 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5249 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5250 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5251 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5252 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5253 are often the only way to detect them.
5254
5255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5257
5258 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5259
5260
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005261option http-keep-alive
5262no option http-keep-alive
5263 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5265 yes | yes | yes | yes
5266 Arguments : none
5267
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005268 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5269 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5270 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5271 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5272 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5273 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5274 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5275
5276 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5277 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005278 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5279 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5280 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5281 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5282 situations where this option may be useful :
5283
5284 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5285 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5286
5287 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5288 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5289
5290 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5291 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5292 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5293 request.
5294
5295 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5296 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005297 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5298 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5299 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005300
5301 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5302 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5303
5304 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5305 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5306 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5307 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5308 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5309 not set.
5310
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005311 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5312 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005313 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005314 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005315
5316 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005317 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5318 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005319
5320
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005321option http-no-delay
5322no option http-no-delay
5323 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5325 yes | yes | yes | yes
5326 Arguments : none
5327
5328 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5329 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5330 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5331 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5332 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5333 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5334 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5335 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5336 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5337 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5338 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5339 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5340 affected.
5341
5342 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5343 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5344 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5345 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5346 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5347 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5348 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5349 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5350 latency environments.
5351
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005352 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5353
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005354
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005355option http-pretend-keepalive
5356no option http-pretend-keepalive
5357 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 yes | yes | yes | yes
5360 Arguments : none
5361
5362 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5363 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5364 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5365 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5366 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5367 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5368 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5369 consider the response complete.
5370
5371 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5372 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5373 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5374 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5375 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5376 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5377
5378 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5379 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5380 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5381 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5382 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5383 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5384 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5385
5386 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5387 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005388 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005389 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5390 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005391
5392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5394
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005395 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5396 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005397
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005398
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005399option http-server-close
5400no option http-server-close
5401 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5403 yes | yes | yes | yes
5404 Arguments : none
5405
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005406 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5407 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5408 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5409 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5410 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5411 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5412 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5413 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5414 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5415 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5416 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5417 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5418 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5419 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5420 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5421 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005422
5423 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5424 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5425 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5426 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005427 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5428 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005429
5430 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5431 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005432 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5433 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005434 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5435 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005436
5437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5439
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005440 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005441 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5442 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005443
5444
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005445option http-tunnel
5446no option http-tunnel
5447 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5449 yes | yes | yes | yes
5450 Arguments : none
5451
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005452 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5453 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5454 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5455 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5456 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5457 "option http-tunnel".
5458
5459 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005460 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005461 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5462 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5463 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5464 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5465 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5466 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5467 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005468
5469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5471
5472 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5473 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5474 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5475
5476
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005477option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005478no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005479 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5481 yes | yes | yes | no
5482 Arguments : none
5483
5484 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5485 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5486 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5487 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5488 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5489 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5490 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5491
5492 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5493 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005494 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5495 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5496 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005497
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005498 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5499 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5500 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5501 front of an existing proxy.
5502
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005503 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5504
5505 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5506 http-server-close".
5507
5508
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005509option httpchk
5510option httpchk <uri>
5511option httpchk <method> <uri>
5512option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5513 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5515 yes | no | yes | yes
5516 Arguments :
5517 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5518 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5519 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5520 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5521 ones.
5522
5523 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5524 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5525 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5526
5527 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5528 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5529 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5530 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5531 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5532
5533 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5534 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5535 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5536 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5537 the lack of any response.
5538
5539 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5540
5541 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5542 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5543 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5544
5545 Examples :
5546 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5547 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5548 backend https_relay
5549 mode tcp
5550 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5551 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5552
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005553 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5554 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5555 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005556
5557
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005558option httpclose
5559no option httpclose
5560 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5562 yes | yes | yes | yes
5563 Arguments : none
5564
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005565 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5566 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5567 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5568 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005569 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005570 "option http-tunnel".
5571
5572 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5573 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5574 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5575 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5576 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5577 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5578 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5579 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005580
5581 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005582 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005583 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5584 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5585 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5586 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5587 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005588
5589 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5590 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005591 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5592 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005593 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5594 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005595
5596 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5597 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5598
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005599 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5600 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005601
5602
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005603option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005604 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5606 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005607 Arguments :
5608 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5609 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5610 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5611 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5612 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005613
5614 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5615 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5616 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5617 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5618 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5619 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5620 ports.
5621
5622 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5623
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005624 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5625 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005627 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005628
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005629
5630option http_proxy
5631no option http_proxy
5632 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5634 yes | yes | yes | yes
5635 Arguments : none
5636
5637 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5638 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5639 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5640 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5641 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5642
5643 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5644 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005645 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5646 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005647
5648 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5649 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5650
5651 Example :
5652 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5653 backend direct_forward
5654 option httpclose
5655 option http_proxy
5656
5657 See also : "option httpclose"
5658
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005659
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005660option independent-streams
5661no option independent-streams
5662 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 yes | yes | yes | yes
5665 Arguments : none
5666
5667 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5668 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5669 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5670 receive data or not.
5671
5672 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5673 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5674 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5675 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5676 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5677 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5678 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5679 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5680 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5681 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5682 socket buffers.
5683
5684 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5685 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5686 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5687 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5688 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5689
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005690 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005691 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5692 deprecated.
5693
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005694 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005695
5696
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005697option ldap-check
5698 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 yes | no | yes | yes
5701 Arguments : none
5702
5703 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5704 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5705 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5706 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5707
5708 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5709 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5710
5711 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5712 configure it.
5713
5714 Example :
5715 option ldap-check
5716
5717 See also : "option httpchk"
5718
5719
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005720option external-check
5721 Use external processes for server health checks
5722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5723 yes | no | yes | yes
5724
5725 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5726 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5727 command".
5728
5729 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5730
5731 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5732
5733
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005734option log-health-checks
5735no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005736 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5738 yes | no | yes | yes
5739 Arguments : none
5740
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005741 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5742 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5743 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005744
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005745 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5746 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5747 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5748 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5749 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5750
5751 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5752 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005753
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005754 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5755 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5756 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005757
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005758
5759option log-separate-errors
5760no option log-separate-errors
5761 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5763 yes | yes | yes | no
5764 Arguments : none
5765
5766 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5767 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5768 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5769 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5770 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5771 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5772 provides very important information.
5773
5774 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5775 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5776 error logs.
5777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005778 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005779 logging.
5780
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005781
5782option logasap
5783no option logasap
5784 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5786 yes | yes | yes | no
5787 Arguments : none
5788
5789 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5790 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5791 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5792 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5793 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5794 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5795 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005796 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005797 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5798 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005800 Examples :
5801 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5802 mode http
5803 option httplog
5804 option logasap
5805 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5806
5807 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5808 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5809 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5810 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005812 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005813 logging.
5814
5815
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005816option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005817 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005820 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005821 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5822 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005823 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005824
5825 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5826 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5827 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5828 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5829 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5830 in the MySQL table, like this :
5831
5832 USE mysql;
5833 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5834 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5835
5836 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5837 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5838 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5839 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5840 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5841 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5842 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5843 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5844 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5845
5846 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5847 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005848
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005849 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005850
5851 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5852 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5853 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5854 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005855 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5856 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005857
5858 See also: "option httpchk"
5859
5860
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005861option nolinger
5862no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005863 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005864 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005866 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005867
5868 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5869 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5870 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5871 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5872 connections.
5873
5874 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5875 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5876 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5877 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5878 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5879 this too.
5880
5881 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5882 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5883 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5884
5885 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5886 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5887 for servers.
5888
5889 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5890 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5891
5892
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005893option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5894 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5896 yes | yes | yes | yes
5897 Arguments :
5898 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5899 matching <network>
5900 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5901 header name.
5902
5903 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5904 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5905 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5906 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5907 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5908 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5909 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5910 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5911 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5912 possible that the client has already brought one.
5913
5914 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5915 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5916 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5917 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5918 header and requires different one.
5919
5920 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5921 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5922 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5923 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5924 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5925 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5926 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5927
5928 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5929 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5930 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5931 both are defined.
5932
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005933 Examples :
5934 # Original Destination address
5935 frontend www
5936 mode http
5937 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5938
5939 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5940 backend www
5941 mode http
5942 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5943
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005944 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5945 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005946
5947
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005948option persist
5949no option persist
5950 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005953 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005954
5955 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5956 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5957 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5958 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5959 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5960 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5961 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5962 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5963 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5964 redirected to another valid server.
5965
5966 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5967 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5968
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005969 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005970
5971
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005972option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5973 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5975 yes | no | yes | yes
5976 Arguments :
5977 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5978 PostgreSQL server.
5979
5980 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5981 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5982 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5983 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5984
5985 See also: "option httpchk"
5986
5987
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005988option prefer-last-server
5989no option prefer-last-server
5990 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5992 yes | no | yes | yes
5993 Arguments : none
5994
5995 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5996 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5997 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5998 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5999 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6000 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6001 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6002 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6003 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006004 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6005 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6006 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6007 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6008 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6009 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6010 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006011
6012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6014
6015 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6016
6017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006018option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006019option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006020no option redispatch
6021 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6023 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006024 Arguments :
6025 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6026 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6027 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6028 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6029 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6030 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6031 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6032 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6033 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006035
6036 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6037 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6038 be able to access the service anymore.
6039
6040 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6041 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6042
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006043 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006044 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6045 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006047 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6048 "redisp" keywords.
6049
6050 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6051 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6052
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006053 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006054
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006055
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006056option redis-check
6057 Use redis health checks for server testing
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 yes | no | yes | yes
6060 Arguments : none
6061
6062 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6063 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6064 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6065 find the "+PONG" response message.
6066
6067 Example :
6068 option redis-check
6069
6070 See also : "option httpchk"
6071
6072
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006073option smtpchk
6074option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6075 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6077 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006078 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006079 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6080 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6081 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6082
6083 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6084 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6085 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6086
6087 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6088 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6089 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6090 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6091 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6092 dead server.
6093
6094 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6095 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6096 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6097 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6098
6099 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6100 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6101 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6102 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006103 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006104
6105 Example :
6106 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6107
6108 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6109
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006110
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006111option socket-stats
6112no option socket-stats
6113
6114 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6116 yes | yes | yes | no
6117
6118 Arguments : none
6119
6120
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006121option splice-auto
6122no option splice-auto
6123 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | yes | yes | yes
6126 Arguments : none
6127
6128 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6129 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6130 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6131 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006132 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006133 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6134 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6135 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6136 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6137
6138 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6139 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6140 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6141 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6142 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6143 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6144 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6145 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6146 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6147 keyword.
6148
6149 Example :
6150 option splice-auto
6151
6152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6154
6155 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6156 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6157
6158
6159option splice-request
6160no option splice-request
6161 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 yes | yes | yes | yes
6164 Arguments : none
6165
6166 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006167 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006168 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6169 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6170 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6171 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6172
6173 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6174
6175 Example :
6176 option splice-request
6177
6178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6180
6181 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6182 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6183
6184
6185option splice-response
6186no option splice-response
6187 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6189 yes | yes | yes | yes
6190 Arguments : none
6191
6192 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006193 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006194 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6195 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6196 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6197 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6198
6199 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6200
6201 Example :
6202 option splice-response
6203
6204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6206
6207 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6208 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6209
6210
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006211option srvtcpka
6212no option srvtcpka
6213 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6215 yes | no | yes | yes
6216 Arguments : none
6217
6218 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6219 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6220 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6221 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6222
6223 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6224 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6225 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6226 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6227
6228 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6229 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6230 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6231 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6232 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6233
6234 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6235
6236 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6237 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6238 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6239
6240 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6241 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6242
6243 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6244
6245
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006246option ssl-hello-chk
6247 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6249 yes | no | yes | yes
6250 Arguments : none
6251
6252 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6253 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6254 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6255 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6256 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6257 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6258 hello message.
6259
6260 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6261 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6262 messages, which is appreciable.
6263
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006264 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6265 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6266 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006267
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006268 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6269
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006270
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006271option tcp-check
6272 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6274 yes | no | yes | yes
6275
6276 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6277 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6278
6279 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6280 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6281 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6282
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006283 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006284 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6285 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6286 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6287 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6288 only.
6289
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006290 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006291 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6292 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6293 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6294 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6295
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006296 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006297 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6298 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006299 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006300 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6301 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6302 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6303 the respective protocols.
6304 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6305 analysed.
6306
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006307 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6308 script.
6309
6310 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6311 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6312 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6313 The "comment" is of course optional.
6314
6315
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006316 Examples :
6317 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6318 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006319 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006320
6321 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6322 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006323 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006324
6325 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6326 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006327 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006328 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006329 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006330 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006331 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006332 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006333 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6334 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006335 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006336 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6337 tcp-check expect string +OK
6338
6339 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6340 (send many headers before analyzing)
6341 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006342 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006343 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6344 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6345 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6346 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006347 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006348
6349
6350 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6351
6352
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006353option tcp-smart-accept
6354no option tcp-smart-accept
6355 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6357 yes | yes | yes | no
6358 Arguments : none
6359
6360 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6361 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6362 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6363 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6364 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6365 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6366
6367 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6368 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6369 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6370 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6371
6372 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6373 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6374 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6375 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6376
6377 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6378 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6379 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6380
6381 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6382 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6383 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6384
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006385 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6386
6387
6388option tcp-smart-connect
6389no option tcp-smart-connect
6390 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6392 yes | no | yes | yes
6393 Arguments : none
6394
6395 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6396 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6397 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6398 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6399 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6400
6401 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6402 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6403 complex.
6404
6405 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6406 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6407 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6408
6409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6411
6412 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6413
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006414
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006415option tcpka
6416 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6418 yes | yes | yes | yes
6419 Arguments : none
6420
6421 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6422 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6423 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6424 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6425
6426 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6427 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6428 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6429 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6430
6431 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6432 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6433 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6434 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6435 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6436
6437 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6438
6439 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6440 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6441 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6442 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6443 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6444 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6445 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6446 backends.
6447
6448 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6449
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006450
6451option tcplog
6452 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | yes | yes | yes
6455 Arguments : none
6456
6457 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6458 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6459 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6460 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6461 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6462 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6463 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6464 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6465
6466 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006468 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006469
6470
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006471option transparent
6472no option transparent
6473 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006475 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006476 Arguments : none
6477
6478 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6479 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6480 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6481 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6482 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6483 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6484 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6485 appropriate server.
6486
6487 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6488 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6489
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006490 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006491 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006492
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006493
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006494external-check command <command>
6495 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6497 yes | no | yes | yes
6498
6499 Arguments :
6500 <command> is the external command to run
6501
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006502 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6503
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006504 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006505
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006506 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6507 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6508 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6509 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6510 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6511 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006512
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006513 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6514
6515 Environment variables :
6516 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6517 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6518
6519 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6520
6521 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6522
6523 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6524 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6525 for a UNIX socket).
6526
6527 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6528
6529 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6530
6531 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6532
6533 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6534
6535 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6536
6537 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6538 socket).
6539
6540 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6541 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6542
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006543 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6544 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6545 failed.
6546
6547 Example :
6548 external-check command /bin/true
6549
6550 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6551
6552
6553external-check path <path>
6554 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | no | yes | yes
6557
6558 Arguments :
6559 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6560
6561 The default path is "".
6562
6563 Example :
6564 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6565
6566 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6567 "external-check command"
6568
6569
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006570persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006571persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006572 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | no | yes | yes
6575 Arguments :
6576 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006577 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6578 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006579
6580 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6581 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6582 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6583 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6584 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6585 forwarded to this server.
6586
6587 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6588 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6589 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006590 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006591 a single "listen" section.
6592
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006593 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6594 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6595 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6596
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006597 Example :
6598 listen tse-farm
6599 bind :3389
6600 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6601 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6602 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6603 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6604 persist rdp-cookie
6605 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006606 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006607 balance rdp-cookie
6608 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6609 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6610
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006611 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6612 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006613
6614
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006615rate-limit sessions <rate>
6616 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6618 yes | yes | yes | no
6619 Arguments :
6620 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6621 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6622
6623 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6624 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6625 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6626 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6627 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6628 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6629
6630 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6631 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6632 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6633 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6634
6635 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6636 listen smtp
6637 mode tcp
6638 bind :25
6639 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006640 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006641
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006642 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6643 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6644 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006645
6646 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6647
6648
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006649redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6650redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6651redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006652 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6654 no | yes | yes | yes
6655
6656 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006657 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006658
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006660 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006661 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6662 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6663 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006664
6665 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6666 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6667 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6668 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6669 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006670 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6671 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6672 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6673 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006674
6675 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6676 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6677 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6678 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6679 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6680 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006681 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006682 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006683 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6684 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6685 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006686
6687 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006688 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6689 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6690 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006691 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006692 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6693 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6694 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6695 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006696
6697 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6698 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6699
6700 - "drop-query"
6701 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6702 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6703 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6704 with a location-type redirect.
6705
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006706 - "append-slash"
6707 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6708 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6709 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6710 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6711
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006712 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6713 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6714 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6715 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6716 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6717 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6718 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6719
6720 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6721 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6722 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6723 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6724 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6725 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6726 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006727
6728 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6729 acl clear dst_port 80
6730 acl secure dst_port 8080
6731 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006732 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006733 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006734 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6735
6736 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006737 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6738 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6739 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006740 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006741
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006742 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6743 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6744 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6745
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006746 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006747 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006748
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006749 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006750 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6751 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6752 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006754 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006755
6756
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006757redisp (deprecated)
6758redispatch (deprecated)
6759 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006762 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006763
6764 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6765 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6766 be able to access the service anymore.
6767
6768 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6769 redistribute them to a working server.
6770
6771 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6772 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6773 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006775 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6776 "option redispatch" instead.
6777
6778 See also : "option redispatch"
6779
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006780
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006781reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006782 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6784 no | yes | yes | yes
6785 Arguments :
6786 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6787 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006788 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006789
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006790 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6791 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6792
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006793 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6794 the last header of an HTTP request.
6795
6796 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6797 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6798 responses.
6799
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006800 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6801 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6802 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6803
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006804 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6805 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006806
6807
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006808reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6809reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006810 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6812 no | yes | yes | yes
6813 Arguments :
6814 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6815 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6816 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6817 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6818 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6819 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6820 ignores case.
6821
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006822 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6823 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6824
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006825 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6826 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6827 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6828 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006829 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006830
6831 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6832 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6833
6834 Example :
6835 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6836 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6837 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6838
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006839 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6840 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006841
6842
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006843reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6844reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006845 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6847 no | yes | yes | yes
6848 Arguments :
6849 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6850 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6851 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6852 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6853 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6854 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6855
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006856 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6857 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6858
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006859 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6860 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6861 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6862 next servers.
6863
6864 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6865 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6866 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6867
6868 Example :
6869 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6870 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6871 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6872
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006873 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6874 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006875
6876
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006877reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6878reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006879 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6881 no | yes | yes | yes
6882 Arguments :
6883 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6884 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6885 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6886 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6887 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6888 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6889 case.
6890
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006891 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6892 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6893
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006894 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6895 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6896 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6897 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006898 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006899
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006900 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006901 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006902 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006903
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006904 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6905 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6906
6907 Example :
6908 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6909 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6910 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6911
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006912 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6913 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006914
6915
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006916reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6917reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006918 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6920 no | yes | yes | yes
6921 Arguments :
6922 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6923 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6924 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6925 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6926 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6927 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6928 case.
6929
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006930 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6931 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6932
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006933 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6934 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6935 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6936 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6937
6938 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6939 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6940
6941 Example :
6942 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6943 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6944 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6945 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6946
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006947 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6948 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006949
6950
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006951reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6952reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006953 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6955 no | yes | yes | yes
6956 Arguments :
6957 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6958 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6959 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6960 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6961 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6962 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6963
6964 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6965 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6966 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6967 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006968 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006969
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006970 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6971 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6972
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006973 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6974 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6975 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6976
6977 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6978 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6979 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6980 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6981 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6982
6983 Example :
6984 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006985 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006986 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6987 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6988
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006989 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6990 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006991
6992
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006993reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6994reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006995 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6997 no | yes | yes | yes
6998 Arguments :
6999 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7000 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7001 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7002 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7003 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7004 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7005 ignores case.
7006
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007007 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7008 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7009
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007010 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7011 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007012 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7013 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7014 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007015 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7016 not set.
7017
7018 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7019 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7020 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7021 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7022 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7023
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007024 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007025 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7026 # block all others.
7027 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7028 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7029
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007030 # block bad guys
7031 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7032 reqitarpit . if badguys
7033
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007034 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7035 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007036
7037
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007038retries <value>
7039 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7040 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7041 yes | no | yes | yes
7042 Arguments :
7043 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7044 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7045 default value is 3.
7046
7047 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7048 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7049 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7050
7051 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007052 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7053 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007054
7055 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7056 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7057
7058 See also : "option redispatch"
7059
7060
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007061rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007062 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7064 no | yes | yes | yes
7065 Arguments :
7066 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7067 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007068 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007069
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007070 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7071 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7072
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007073 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7074 the last header of an HTTP response.
7075
7076 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7077 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7078 responses.
7079
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007080 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7081 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007082
7083
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007084rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7085rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007086 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7088 no | yes | yes | yes
7089 Arguments :
7090 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7091 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7092 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7093 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7094 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7095 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7096 ignores case.
7097
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007098 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7099 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7100
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007101 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7102 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007103 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007104 client.
7105
7106 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7107 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7108 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7109
7110 Example :
7111 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007112 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007113
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007114 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7115 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007116
7117
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007118rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7119rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007120 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7122 no | yes | yes | yes
7123 Arguments :
7124 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7125 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7126 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7127 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7128 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7129 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7130 ignores case.
7131
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007132 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7133 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7134
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007135 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7136 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7137 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7138 case-sensitive.
7139
7140 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007141 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7142 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7143 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007144
7145 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7146 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7147
7148 Example :
7149 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7150 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7151
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007152 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7153 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007154
7155
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007156rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7157rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007158 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7160 no | yes | yes | yes
7161 Arguments :
7162 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7163 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7164 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7165 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7166 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7167 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7168 ignores case.
7169
7170 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7171 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7172 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7173 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007174 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007175
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007176 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7177 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7178
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007179 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7180 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7181 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7182
7183 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7184 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7185 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7186 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7187 are not case-sensitive.
7188
7189 Example :
7190 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7191 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7192
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007193 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7194 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007195
7196
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007197server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007198 Declare a server in a backend
7199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7200 no | no | yes | yes
7201 Arguments :
7202 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007203 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007204 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007205
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007206 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7207 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7208 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7209 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007210 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7211 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7212 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7213 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7214 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007215 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7216 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7217 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7218 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7219 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7220 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7221 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007222 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007223 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7224 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7225 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007226
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007227 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007228 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7229 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7230 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7231 adding this value to the client's port.
7232
7233 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7234 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007235 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007236
7237 Examples :
7238 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7239 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007240 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007241 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7242 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7243 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007244
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007245 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7246 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7247 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7248 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7249 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7250
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007251 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7252 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007253
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007254server-state-file-name [<file>]
7255 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7256 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7257 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7258 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7259 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7260 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7261
7262 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7263 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7264
7265 global
7266 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7267
7268 backend bk
7269 load-server-state-from-file
7270
7271 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7272 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007273
7274source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007275source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007276source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007277 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7279 yes | no | yes | yes
7280 Arguments :
7281 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7282 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007283
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007284 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007285 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7286 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7287 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7288 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7289 supported prefixes are :
7290 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7291 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7292 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007293 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007294 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7295 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007296
7297 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7298 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007299 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7300 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7301 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007302
7303 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7304 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7305 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7306 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7307 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7308 <addr>.
7309
7310 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7311 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7312 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7313 port.
7314
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007315 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7316 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7317 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7318 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007319 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007320 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7321 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7322 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7323 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7324 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7325 HTTP header.
7326
7327 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7328 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007329 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007330 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7331 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7332 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7333 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7334 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7335 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7336 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7337
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007338 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7339 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7340 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7341 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7342 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7343 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7344
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007345 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7346 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7347 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7348 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7349
7350 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7351 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7352 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7353 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7354 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7355 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7356
7357 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7358 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7359 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7360 there are two methods :
7361
7362 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7363 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7364 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7365 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7366 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7367 of the client ranges may be used.
7368
7369 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7370 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7371 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7372 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7373 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7374 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7375 same session.
7376
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007377 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7378 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7379 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007380 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007381
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007382 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7383
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007384 Examples :
7385 backend private
7386 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7387 source 192.168.1.200
7388
7389 backend transparent_ssl1
7390 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7391 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7392
7393 backend transparent_ssl2
7394 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7395 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7396 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7397
7398 backend transparent_ssl3
7399 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7400 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7401 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7402
7403 backend transparent_smtp
7404 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7405 # with Tproxy version 4.
7406 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7407
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007408 backend transparent_http
7409 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7410 # proxy.
7411 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007413 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007414 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007416
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007417srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7418 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7420 yes | no | yes | yes
7421 Arguments :
7422 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7423 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7424 as explained at the top of this document.
7425
7426 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7427 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7428 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7429 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7430 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7431 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7432 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7433
7434 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7435 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7436 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7437 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7438 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007439 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007440 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007441 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007442
7443 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7444 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7445 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7446 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7447 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7448 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7449
7450 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7451 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7452
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007453 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7454 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007455
7456
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007457stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7458 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007460 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007461
7462 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7463 matched.
7464
7465 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7466 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7467
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007468 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7469 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7470 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7471
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007472 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7473 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7474 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7475 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007476
7477 Example :
7478 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7479 backend stats_localhost
7480 stats enable
7481 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7482
7483 Example :
7484 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7485 backend stats_auth
7486 stats enable
7487 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7488 stats admin if TRUE
7489
7490 Example :
7491 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7492 userlist stats-auth
7493 group admin users admin
7494 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7495 group readonly users haproxy
7496 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7497
7498 backend stats_auth
7499 stats enable
7500 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7501 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7502 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7503 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7504
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007505 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7506 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7507 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007508
7509
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007510stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7511 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007513 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007514 Arguments :
7515 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7516
7517 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7518
7519 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7520 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7521 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7522 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7523 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7524 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7525
7526 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7527 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7528 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007529 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007530
7531 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7532 report using "stats scope".
7533
7534 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7535 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7536 unobvious parameters.
7537
7538 Example :
7539 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7540 backend public_www
7541 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7542 stats enable
7543 stats hide-version
7544 stats scope .
7545 stats uri /admin?stats
7546 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7547 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7548 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7549
7550 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7551 backend private_monitoring
7552 stats enable
7553 stats uri /admin?stats
7554 stats refresh 5s
7555
7556 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7557
7558
7559stats enable
7560 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007562 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007563 Arguments : none
7564
7565 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7566 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7567 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7568 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7569 - stats auth : no authentication
7570 - stats scope : no restriction
7571
7572 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7573 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7574 unobvious parameters.
7575
7576 Example :
7577 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7578 backend public_www
7579 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7580 stats enable
7581 stats hide-version
7582 stats scope .
7583 stats uri /admin?stats
7584 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7585 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7586 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7587
7588 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7589 backend private_monitoring
7590 stats enable
7591 stats uri /admin?stats
7592 stats refresh 5s
7593
7594 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7595
7596
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007597stats hide-version
7598 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007600 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007601 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007602
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007603 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7604 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7605 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7606 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7607 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7608 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007610 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7611 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7612 unobvious parameters.
7613
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007614 Example :
7615 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7616 backend public_www
7617 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007618 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007619 stats hide-version
7620 stats scope .
7621 stats uri /admin?stats
7622 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7623 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7624 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007625
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007626 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7627 backend private_monitoring
7628 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007629 stats uri /admin?stats
7630 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007631
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007632 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007633
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007634
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007635stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7636 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7637 Access control for statistics
7638
7639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7640 no | no | yes | yes
7641
7642 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7643 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7644 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7645 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7646 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7647 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7648
7649 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7650 instance.
7651
7652 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7653 about ACL usage.
7654
7655
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007656stats realm <realm>
7657 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007659 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007660 Arguments :
7661 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7662 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7663 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7664
7665 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7666 using a backslash ('\').
7667
7668 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7669 only related to authentication.
7670
7671 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7672 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7673 unobvious parameters.
7674
7675 Example :
7676 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7677 backend public_www
7678 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7679 stats enable
7680 stats hide-version
7681 stats scope .
7682 stats uri /admin?stats
7683 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7684 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7685 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7686
7687 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7688 backend private_monitoring
7689 stats enable
7690 stats uri /admin?stats
7691 stats refresh 5s
7692
7693 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7694
7695
7696stats refresh <delay>
7697 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007699 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007700 Arguments :
7701 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7702 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7703 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7704 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7705 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7706 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7707
7708 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7709 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7710 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7711 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7712
7713 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7714 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7715 unobvious parameters.
7716
7717 Example :
7718 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7719 backend public_www
7720 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7721 stats enable
7722 stats hide-version
7723 stats scope .
7724 stats uri /admin?stats
7725 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7726 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7727 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7728
7729 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7730 backend private_monitoring
7731 stats enable
7732 stats uri /admin?stats
7733 stats refresh 5s
7734
7735 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7736
7737
7738stats scope { <name> | "." }
7739 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007742 Arguments :
7743 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7744 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7745 section in which the statement appears.
7746
7747 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7748 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7749 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7750 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7751 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7752 exists.
7753
7754 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7755 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7756 unobvious parameters.
7757
7758 Example :
7759 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7760 backend public_www
7761 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7762 stats enable
7763 stats hide-version
7764 stats scope .
7765 stats uri /admin?stats
7766 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7767 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7768 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7769
7770 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7771 backend private_monitoring
7772 stats enable
7773 stats uri /admin?stats
7774 stats refresh 5s
7775
7776 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7777
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007778
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007779stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007780 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007782 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007783
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007784 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007785 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7786
7787 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7788 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7789
7790 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7791 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007792 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007793
7794 Example :
7795 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7796 backend private_monitoring
7797 stats enable
7798 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7799 stats uri /admin?stats
7800 stats refresh 5s
7801
7802 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7803 global section.
7804
7805
7806stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007807 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7809 yes | yes | yes | yes
7810 Arguments : none
7811
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007812 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007813 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7814 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7815 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7816 - IP (socket, server)
7817 - cookie (backend, server)
7818
7819 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7820 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007821 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007822
7823 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7824
7825
7826stats show-node [ <name> ]
7827 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007829 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007830 Arguments:
7831 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7832 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7833
7834 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7835 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007836 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007837
7838 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7839 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7840 unobvious parameters.
7841
7842 Example:
7843 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7844 backend private_monitoring
7845 stats enable
7846 stats show-node Europe-1
7847 stats uri /admin?stats
7848 stats refresh 5s
7849
7850 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7851 section.
7852
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007853
7854stats uri <prefix>
7855 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007857 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007858 Arguments :
7859 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7860 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7861 query string.
7862
7863 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7864 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7865 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7866 possible to reach it in the application.
7867
7868 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007869 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007870 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7871 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7872 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7873 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7874
7875 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7876 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7877 an address or a port to statistics only.
7878
7879 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7880 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7881 unobvious parameters.
7882
7883 Example :
7884 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7885 backend public_www
7886 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7887 stats enable
7888 stats hide-version
7889 stats scope .
7890 stats uri /admin?stats
7891 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7892 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7893 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7894
7895 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7896 backend private_monitoring
7897 stats enable
7898 stats uri /admin?stats
7899 stats refresh 5s
7900
7901 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7902
7903
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007904stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7905 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007907 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007908
7909 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007910 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007911 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7912 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7913 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7914
7915 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7916 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7917 the "stick-table" statement.
7918
7919 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7920 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7921 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7922 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7923 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7924
7925 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7926 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7927 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7928 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7929 transformation rules.
7930
7931 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7932 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7933 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7934 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7935 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7936 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7937 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7938
7939 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7940 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7941 ACL based conditions.
7942
7943 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7944 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7945 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7946 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7947
7948 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7949 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7950 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7951 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7952
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007953 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7954 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7955 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7956
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007957 Example :
7958 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7959 # last 30 minutes
7960 backend pop
7961 mode tcp
7962 balance roundrobin
7963 stick store-request src
7964 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7965 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7966 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7967
7968 backend smtp
7969 mode tcp
7970 balance roundrobin
7971 stick match src table pop
7972 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7973 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7974
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007975 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007976 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007977
7978
7979stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7980 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 no | no | yes | yes
7983
7984 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7985 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7986 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7987 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7988
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007989 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7990 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7991 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7992
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007993 Examples :
7994 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007995 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007996
7997 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7998 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7999 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8000
8001
8002 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8003 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8004 backend http
8005 mode http
8006 balance roundrobin
8007 stick on src table https
8008 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8009 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8010 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8011
8012 backend https
8013 mode tcp
8014 balance roundrobin
8015 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8016 stick on src
8017 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8018 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8019
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008020 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008021
8022
8023stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8024 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8026 no | no | yes | yes
8027
8028 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008029 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008030 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8031 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8032 server is selected.
8033
8034 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8035 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8036 the "stick-table" statement.
8037
8038 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8039 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8040 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8041 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8042 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8043 address.
8044
8045 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8046 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8047 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8048 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8049 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8050 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8051 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8052 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8053 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8054 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8055
8056 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8057 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8058 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8059 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8060 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8061 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8062 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8063
8064 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8065 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8066 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8067 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8068
8069 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8070 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8071 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8072 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8073 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8074 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008075 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8076 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8077 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8078 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8079 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8080 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008081
8082 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8083 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8084 the request.
8085
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008086 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8087 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8088 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8089
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008090 Example :
8091 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8092 # last 30 minutes
8093 backend pop
8094 mode tcp
8095 balance roundrobin
8096 stick store-request src
8097 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8098 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8099 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8100
8101 backend smtp
8102 mode tcp
8103 balance roundrobin
8104 stick match src table pop
8105 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8106 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8107
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008108 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008109 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008110
8111
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008112stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008113 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8114 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008115 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008117 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008118
8119 Arguments :
8120 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8121 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8122 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8123 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8124
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008125 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8126 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8127 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8128 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8129
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008130 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8131 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8132 instance.
8133
8134 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8135 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8136 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8137 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8138 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8139 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008140 to 32 characters.
8141
8142 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8143 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8144 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008145 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008146 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8147 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008148
8149 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008150 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8151 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008152 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8153 increase.
8154
8155 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008156 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8157 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8158 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008159
8160 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8161 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8162 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8163 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8164 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8165 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8166 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8167 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8168 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8169 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8170 parameter (see below).
8171
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008172 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8173 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8174 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8175 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8176 soft restart.
8177
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008178 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8179 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008180
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008181 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8182 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8183 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8184 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8185 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008186 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008187 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8188 if not expiration delay is specified.
8189
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008190 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8191 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8192 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8193 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008194 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8195 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8196 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8197 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8198 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8199 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8200 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8201 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8202 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8203 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8204 types and their arguments.
8205
8206 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8207 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8208 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8209 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8210
8211 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8212 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8213 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8214 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8215
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008216 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8217 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8218 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8219 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8220 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8221 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8222
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008223 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8224 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8225 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8226 they were received.
8227
8228 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8229 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8230 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8231 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8232 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8233
8234 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8235 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8236 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8237 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8238 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8239
8240 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8241 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8242 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8243
8244 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8245 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8246 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8247 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8248 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8249
8250 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8251 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8252 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8253 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8254 the client side.
8255
8256 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8257 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8258 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8259 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8260 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8261 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8262 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8263
8264 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8265 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8266 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8267 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8268 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8269 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8270 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8271
8272 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8273 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8274 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8275 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8276 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8277 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8278
8279 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8280 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8281 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8282 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8283
8284 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8285 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8286 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8287 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8288 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8289 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8290 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8291 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8292 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8293 recommended for better fairness.
8294
8295 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8296 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8297 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8298 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8299
8300 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8301 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8302 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8303 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8304 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8305 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8306 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8307 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8308 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8309 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008310
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008311 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8312 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008313 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8314 reference it.
8315
8316 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8317 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008318 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8319 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8320 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008321
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008322 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8323 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8324 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8325 something that can be ignored.
8326
8327 Example:
8328 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8329 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8330 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8331 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8332
8333 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008334 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008335
8336
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008337stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008338 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8340 no | no | yes | yes
8341
8342 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008343 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008344 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8345 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8346 server is selected.
8347
8348 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8349 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8350 the "stick-table" statement.
8351
8352 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8353 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8354 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8355 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8356
8357 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8358 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8359 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8360 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8361 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8362 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008363 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008364 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8365 rules.
8366
8367 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8368 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8369 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8370 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8371 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8372 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8373 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8374
8375 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8376 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8377 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8378 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8379
8380 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8381 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8382 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8383 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8384 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8385 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008386 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8387 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8388 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8389 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8390 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8391 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8392 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8393 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8394 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008395
8396 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8397
8398 Example :
8399 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8400 backend https
8401 mode tcp
8402 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008403 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008404 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008405
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008406 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8407 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8408
8409 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8410 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8411 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8412
8413 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8414 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008415
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008416 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8417 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8418 # at offset 44.
8419
8420 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8421 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8422
8423 # Learn on response if server hello.
8424 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008425
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008426 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8427 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8428
8429 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8430 extraction.
8431
8432
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008433tcp-check connect [params*]
8434 Opens a new connection
8435 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 no | no | yes | yes
8437
8438 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8439 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8440 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8441
8442 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8443 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8444 of the sequence.
8445
8446 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8447 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8448 do.
8449
8450 Parameters :
8451 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8452 use the TCP connection.
8453
8454 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8455 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8456 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8457
8458 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8459
8460 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8461
8462 Examples:
8463 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8464 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8465 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8466 option tcp-check
8467 tcp-check connect
8468 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8469 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8470 tcp-check send \r\n
8471 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8472 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8473 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8474 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8475 tcp-check send \r\n
8476 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8477 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8478
8479 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8480 option tcp-check
8481 tcp-check connect port 110
8482 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8483 tcp-check connect port 143
8484 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8485 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8486
8487 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8488
8489
8490tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8491 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8493 no | no | yes | yes
8494
8495 Arguments :
8496 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8497 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8498 binary.
8499 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8500 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8501 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8502
8503 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8504 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8505 with the usual backslash ('\').
8506 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8507 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8508 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8509 used upper or lower case.
8510
8511
8512 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8513
8514 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8515 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8516 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8517 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8518 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8519 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8520 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8521 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8522
8523 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8524 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8525 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8526 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8527 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8528 expression.
8529
8530 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8531 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8532 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8533 this exact hexadecimal string.
8534 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8535
8536 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8537 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8538 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8539 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8540 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8541 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8542 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8543 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8544 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8545 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8546 the null character.
8547
8548 Examples :
8549 # perform a POP check
8550 option tcp-check
8551 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8552
8553 # perform an IMAP check
8554 option tcp-check
8555 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8556
8557 # look for the redis master server
8558 option tcp-check
8559 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008560 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008561 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8562 tcp-check expect string role:master
8563 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8564 tcp-check expect string +OK
8565
8566
8567 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8568 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8569
8570
8571tcp-check send <data>
8572 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8573 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8574 no | no | yes | yes
8575
8576 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8577 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8578
8579 Examples :
8580 # look for the redis master server
8581 option tcp-check
8582 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8583 tcp-check expect string role:master
8584
8585 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8586 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8587
8588
8589tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8590 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8591 tcp health check
8592 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8593 no | no | yes | yes
8594
8595 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8596 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8597 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8598 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8599 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8600 hexadecimal string.
8601 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8602
8603 Examples :
8604 # redis check in binary
8605 option tcp-check
8606 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8607 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8608
8609
8610 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8611 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8612
8613
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008614tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8615 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8617 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008619 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8620 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008621
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008622 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008623
8624 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8625 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008626 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8627 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8628 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8629 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8630 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8631 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008632
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008633 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8634 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8635 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8636 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008637
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008638 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008639 - accept :
8640 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8641 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8642 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008643
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008644 - reject :
8645 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8646 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8647 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8648 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8649 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8650 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8651 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8652 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8653 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8654 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8655 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8656 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008657
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008658 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8659 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8660 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8661 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8662 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8663 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8664 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8665 hosts.
8666
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008667 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8668 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8669 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8670 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8671 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8672 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8673 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8674 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8675
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008676 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8677 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8678 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8679 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8680 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8681 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8682 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8683 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8684 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008685 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8686 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008687
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008688 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008689 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008690 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008691 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008692 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8693 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008694 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008695 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8696 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8697 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8698 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8699 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008700
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008701 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008702 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008703 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008704 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8705 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8706 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8707 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008709 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8710 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8711 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8712 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008714 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8715 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8716 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8717 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8718 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008719 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8720 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8721 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8722 layer7 information is extracted.
8723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008724 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8725 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8726 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8727 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8728 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008729
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008730 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8731 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8732 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8733 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8734
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008735 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8736 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8737 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8738 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8739 continues.
8740
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008741 - set-src <expr> :
8742 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8743 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8744 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8745 set-src"
8746
8747 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8748 followed by some converters.
8749
8750 Example:
8751
8752 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8753
8754 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
8755
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008756 - set-src-port <expr> :
8757 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8758 expression.
8759
8760 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8761 followed by some converters.
8762
8763 Example:
8764
8765 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8766
8767 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
8768 the source port to 0.
8769
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008770 - set-dst <expr> :
8771 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8772 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8773 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8774 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8775 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8776
8777 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8778 followed by some converters.
8779
8780 Example:
8781
8782 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8783 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8784
8785 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8786 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8787 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8788 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8789
8790
8791 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8792 followed by some converters.
8793
8794 Example:
8795
8796 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8797
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008798 - "silent-drop" :
8799 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8800 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8801 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8802 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8803 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8804 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8805 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8806 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8807 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8808 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8809 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8810 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8811 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8812 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8813 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8814 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8815
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008816 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8817 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8818 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008819
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008820 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8821 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8822 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008823
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008824 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008825 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008826 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008827
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008828 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8829 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8830 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008832 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008833 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8834 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008835
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008836 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8837
8838 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8839
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008840 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8841
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008842 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008843
8844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008845tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8846 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008848 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008849 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008850 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8851 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008852
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008853 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008854
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008855 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8856 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8857 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8858 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8859 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008861 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8862 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8863 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8864 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008865 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8866 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8867 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8868 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8869 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8870 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008871 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008872 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008874 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8875 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8876 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8877 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008878
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008879 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008880 - accept : the request is accepted
8881 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8882 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008883 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008884 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008885 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008886 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008887 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008889 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8890 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008891
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008892 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8893 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8894 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8895 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8896 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8897 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008899 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008900 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8901 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008903 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008904 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8905 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8906 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8907 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008908 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8909 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8910 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008911
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008912 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008913 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8914 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8915 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008916
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008917 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8918 declared inline.
8919
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008920 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8921 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8922 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8923 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008924 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008925 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008926 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008927 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8928 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008929 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008930 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8931 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008932
8933 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8934 followed by some converters.
8935
8936 Example:
8937
8938 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8939
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008940 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008941 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8942 # and reject everything else.
8943 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8944 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008945 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008946 tcp-request content reject
8947
8948 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008949 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8950 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8951 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008952 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008953
8954 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8955 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8956 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008957 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008958 tcp-request content reject
8959
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008960 Example:
8961 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8962 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008963 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008964
8965 Example:
8966 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8967 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008968 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008969
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008970 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8971 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8972
8973 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008974 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008975 # protecting all our sites
8976 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008977 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8978 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008979 ...
8980 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8981
8982 backend http_dynamic
8983 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008984 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008985 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008986 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8987 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8988 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008989 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008991 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008993 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008994
8995
8996tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8997 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008999 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009000 Arguments :
9001 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9002 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9003 as explained at the top of this document.
9004
9005 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9006 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9007 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9008 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9009 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9010
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009011 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9012 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9013 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9014 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9015
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009016 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9017 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009018 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009019 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009020 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9021 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9022 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9023 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009024
9025 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9026 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9027 it pass through unaffected.
9028
9029 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9030 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9031 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009032 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009033 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9034 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009035 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9036 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9037 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009038
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009039 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009040 "timeout client".
9041
9042
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009043tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9044 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 no | no | yes | yes
9047 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009048 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9049 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009050
9051 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9052
9053 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9054 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9055 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009056 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9057 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009058
9059 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9060
9061 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9062 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9063 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9064 inserted.
9065
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009066 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009067 - accept :
9068 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9069 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9070 the rules evaluation.
9071
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009072 - close :
9073 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9074 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9075 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9076 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9077 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9078 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009079 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009080 protocols.
9081
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009082 - reject :
9083 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9084 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009085 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009086
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009087 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9088 Sets a variable.
9089
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009090 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9091 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9092 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9093 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9094
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009095 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9096 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9097 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9098 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9099 continues.
9100
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009101 - "silent-drop" :
9102 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9103 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9104 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9105 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9106 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9107 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9108 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9109 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9110 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9111 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9112 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9113 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9114 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9115 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9116 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9117 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9118
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009119 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9120 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9121 for changing the default action to a reject.
9122
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009123 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9124 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9125 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9126 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009127 period.
9128
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009129 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9130 declared inline.
9131
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009132 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9133 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9134 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9135 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009136 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009137 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009138 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009139 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9140 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009141 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009142 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9143 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009144
9145 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9146 followed by some converters.
9147
9148 Example:
9149
9150 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9151
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009152 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9153
9154 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9155
9156
9157tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9158 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9160 no | no | yes | yes
9161 Arguments :
9162 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9163 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9164 as explained at the top of this document.
9165
9166 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9167
9168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009169timeout check <timeout>
9170 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9171 established.
9172
9173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9174 yes | no | yes | yes
9175 Arguments:
9176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9178 as explained at the top of this document.
9179
9180 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9181 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9182 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9183 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009184 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9185 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9186 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009187
9188 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9189 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9190
9191 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9192 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009193 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009194
9195 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9196 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9197 forget about it.
9198
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009199 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9200 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009201
9202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009203timeout client <timeout>
9204timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9205 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9207 yes | yes | yes | no
9208 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9211 as explained at the top of this document.
9212
9213 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9214 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9215 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009216 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9217 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9218 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9219 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009220 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9221 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9222 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009223 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009224 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009225 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9226 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009227 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9228 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009229
9230 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9231 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9232 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9233 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9234 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9235 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9236
9237 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9238 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9239 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9240
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009241 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9242 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009243
9244
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009245timeout client-fin <timeout>
9246 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9248 yes | yes | yes | no
9249 Arguments :
9250 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9251 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9252 as explained at the top of this document.
9253
9254 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9255 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9256 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9257 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9258 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9259 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9260 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9261 down in one direction.
9262
9263 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9264 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9265 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9266
9267 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9268
9269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009270timeout connect <timeout>
9271timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9272 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9274 yes | no | yes | yes
9275 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009276 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009277 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9278 as explained at the top of this document.
9279
9280 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009281 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009282 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009283 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009284 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9285 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009286
9287 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9288 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9289 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9290 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9291 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9292 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9293
9294 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9295 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9296 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9297
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009298 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9299 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009300
9301
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009302timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9303 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9305 yes | yes | yes | yes
9306 Arguments :
9307 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9308 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9309 as explained at the top of this document.
9310
9311 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9312 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9313 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9314 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9315 once the request has started to present itself.
9316
9317 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9318 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9319 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9320 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9321 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9322
9323 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9324 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9325 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9326 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9327
9328 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9329 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9330 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9331 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9332 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009333 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009334
9335 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9336 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9337 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9338 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9339
9340 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9341
9342
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009343timeout http-request <timeout>
9344 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009346 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009347 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009348 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009349 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9350 as explained at the top of this document.
9351
9352 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9353 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9354 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9355 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9356 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9357 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9358 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009359 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9360 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9361 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9362 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9363 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009364 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9365 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009366
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009367 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9368 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9369 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9370 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9371 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009372 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009373
9374 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9375 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9376 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9377 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9378 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9379
9380 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009381 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9382 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9383 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009384
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009385 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009386 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009387
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009388
9389timeout queue <timeout>
9390 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9392 yes | no | yes | yes
9393 Arguments :
9394 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9395 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9396 as explained at the top of this document.
9397
9398 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9399 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9400 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9401 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9402 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9403
9404 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9405 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9406 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9407 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9408
9409 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9410
9411
9412timeout server <timeout>
9413timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9414 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9416 yes | no | yes | yes
9417 Arguments :
9418 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9419 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9420 as explained at the top of this document.
9421
9422 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9423 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9424 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9425 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9426 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9427 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9428 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9429
9430 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9431 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9432 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9433 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9434 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009435 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009436 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009437 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9438 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9439 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9440 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009441
9442 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9443 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9444 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9445 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9446 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9447 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9448
9449 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9450 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9451 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9452
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009453 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009454
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009455
9456timeout server-fin <timeout>
9457 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9459 yes | no | yes | yes
9460 Arguments :
9461 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9462 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9463 as explained at the top of this document.
9464
9465 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9466 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9467 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9468 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9469 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9470 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9471 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9472 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9473 situations, it should not be needed.
9474
9475 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9476 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9477 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9478
9479 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9480
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009481
9482timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009483 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9485 yes | yes | yes | yes
9486 Arguments :
9487 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9488 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9489 as explained at the top of this document.
9490
9491 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9492 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9493 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9494
9495 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9496 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9497 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9498 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009499 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009500
9501 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9502
9503
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009504timeout tunnel <timeout>
9505 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9507 yes | no | yes | yes
9508 Arguments :
9509 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9511 as explained at the top of this document.
9512
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009513 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009514 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9515 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9516 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9517 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9518 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9519 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9520 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9521 specified.
9522
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009523 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9524 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9525 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9526 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9527 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9528 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9529 state.
9530
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009531 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9532 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9533 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9534 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9535 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9536
9537 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9538 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9539 forget about it.
9540
9541 Example :
9542 defaults http
9543 option http-server-close
9544 timeout connect 5s
9545 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009546 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009547 timeout server 30s
9548 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9549
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009550 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009551
9552
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009553transparent (deprecated)
9554 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009556 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009557 Arguments : none
9558
9559 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9560 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9561 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9562 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9563 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9564 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9565 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9566 appropriate server.
9567
9568 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9569
9570 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9571 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9572
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009573 See also: "option transparent"
9574
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009575unique-id-format <string>
9576 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9578 yes | yes | yes | no
9579 Arguments :
9580 <string> is a log-format string.
9581
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009582 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9583 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9584 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9585 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009586
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009587 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9588 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9589 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9590 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9591 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9592 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9593 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9594 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009595
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009596 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9597 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009599 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009600
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009601 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009602
9603 will generate:
9604
9605 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9606
9607 See also: "unique-id-header"
9608
9609unique-id-header <name>
9610 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9612 yes | yes | yes | no
9613 Arguments :
9614 <name> is the name of the header.
9615
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009616 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9617 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009618
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009619 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009620
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009621 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009622 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9623
9624 will generate:
9625
9626 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9627
9628 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009629
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009630use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009631 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9633 no | yes | yes | no
9634 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009635 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9636 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009637
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009638 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9639 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009640
9641 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9642 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9643 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009644 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9645 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9646 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9647 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009648
9649 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9650 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9651 assign the backend.
9652
9653 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9654 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9655 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9656 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9657 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9658 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9659
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009660 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009661 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009662 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9663 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9664 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9665
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009666 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9667 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9668 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9669 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9670 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9671 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9672 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9673 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9674 cannot be forced from the request.
9675
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009676 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009677 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9678 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9679
9680 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9681 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009682
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009683
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009684use-server <server> if <condition>
9685use-server <server> unless <condition>
9686 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9688 no | no | yes | yes
9689 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009690 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009691
9692 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9693
9694 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9695 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9696 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9697
9698 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9699 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9700 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9701 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9702 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9703 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9704 matches will assign the server.
9705
9706 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9707 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9708 with the next rules until one matches.
9709
9710 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9711 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9712 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9713 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9714
9715 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9716 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9717 stripped.
9718
9719 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9720 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9721 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9722 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9723
9724 Example :
9725 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9726 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9727 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9728 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9729 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9730 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9731 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9732 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9733 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9734
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009735 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009736
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009737
97385. Bind and Server options
9739--------------------------
9740
9741The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9742depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9743settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9744written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9745described in this section.
9746
9747
97485.1. Bind options
9749-----------------
9750
9751The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9752as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9753no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9754parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9755while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9756provided immediately after the setting name.
9757
9758The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9759
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009760accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9761 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9762 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9763 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9764 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9765 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9766 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9767 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9768 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9769 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009770 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9771 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
9772 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009773
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009774accept-proxy
9775 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009776 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9777 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009778 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9779 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9780 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9781 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9782 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9783 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9784 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009785 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9786 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009787
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009788alpn <protocols>
9789 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9790 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9791 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9792 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9793 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9794 initial NPN extension.
9795
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009796backlog <backlog>
9797 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9798 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9799
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009800ecdhe <named curve>
9801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009802 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9803 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009804
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009805ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009806 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9807 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9808 client's certificate.
9809
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009810ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9812 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9813 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9814 error is ignored.
9815
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009816ca-sign-file <cafile>
9817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9818 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9819 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9820 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9821 'generate-certificates' for details.
9822
9823ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9825 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9826 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9827 'generate-certificates' for details.
9828
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009829ciphers <ciphers>
9830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9831 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009832 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009833 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9834 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9835
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009836crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9838 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9839 to verify client's certificate.
9840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009841crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9843 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9844 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9845 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9846 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9847 file.
9848
9849 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9850 are loaded.
9851
9852 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009853 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009854 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9855 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9856 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9857 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9858 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9859 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9860 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009861
9862 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9863 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9864 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9865 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009866 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9867 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009868
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009869 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009870
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009871 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9872 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009873 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009874 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9875 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9876 clients).
9877
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009878 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9879 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9880 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9881 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9882 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9883 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9884 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9885 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9886 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9887 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9888 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9889 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9890 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9891
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009892 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9893 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9894 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9895 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9896 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9897
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009898 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9899 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9900 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9901 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009902
9903 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9904 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9905 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9906 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9907 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9908 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9909 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9910 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9911 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9912
9913 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9914
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009915 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009916 a cert bundle.
9917
9918 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9919 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9920 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9921 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9922 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9923 provide multi-cert support.
9924
9925 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9926
9927 Filename | CN | SAN
9928 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9929 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009930 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009931 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9932 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9933
9934 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9935 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9936 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9937 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9938 suites.
9939
9940 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9941 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9942
9943 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9944 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9945 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9946
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009947crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009948 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9949 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009950 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009951 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009952
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009953crt-list <file>
9954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009955 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9956 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009957
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009958 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009959
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009960 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9961 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9962 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9963 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9964 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9965 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9966 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9967 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009968
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009969 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +02009970 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
9971 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009973defer-accept
9974 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9975 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9976 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9977 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9978 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9979 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9980 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9981 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9982 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9983 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9984 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9985
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009986force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009987 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009988 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009989 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9990 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009991
9992force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009993 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009994 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9995 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009996
9997force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009998 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009999 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10000 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010001
10002force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010003 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010004 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10005 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010006
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010007generate-certificates
10008 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10009 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10010 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10011 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10012 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10013 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10014 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10015 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10016 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10017 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10018 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10019
10020 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10021 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10022 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10023 certificate is used many times.
10024
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010025gid <gid>
10026 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10027 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10028 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10029 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10030 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10031
10032group <group>
10033 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10034 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10035 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10036 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10037 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10038
10039id <id>
10040 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10041 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10042 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10043 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10044
10045interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010046 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10047 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10048 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10049 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10050 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10051 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10052 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010053
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010054level <level>
10055 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10056 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10057 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10058 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10059 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10060 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10061 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10062 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10063 counters).
10064 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10065 all counters).
10066
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010067maxconn <maxconn>
10068 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10069 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10070 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10071 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10072 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10073 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10074 eat all memory.
10075
10076mode <mode>
10077 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10078 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10079 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10080 UNIX sockets.
10081
10082mss <maxseg>
10083 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10084 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10085 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10086 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10087 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10088 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10089 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10090 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10091 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10092 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10093 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10094
10095name <name>
10096 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10097 page.
10098
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010099namespace <name>
10100 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10101 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10102 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10103 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10104
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010105nice <nice>
10106 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10107 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10108 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10109 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10110 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10111 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10112 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10113 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10114 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10115 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10116 one for an RDP socket.
10117
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010118no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010120 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010121 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010122 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10123 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010124 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010125
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010126no-tls-tickets
10127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10128 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10129 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010130 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10131 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010132
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010133no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010135 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010136 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010137 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10138 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10139 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010140
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010141no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010142 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010143 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010144 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010145 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10146 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10147 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010148
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010149no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010151 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010152 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010153 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10154 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10155 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010156
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010157npn <protocols>
10158 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10159 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10160 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10161 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010162 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10163 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010164
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010165process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10166 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10167 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10168 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10169 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10170 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10171 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10172 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010173 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10174 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10175 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10176 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10177 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10178 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10179 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010180
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010181ssl
10182 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010183 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010184 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10185 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10186 to deciphered contents.
10187
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010188strict-sni
10189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10190 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10191 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10192 See the "crt" option for more information.
10193
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010194tcp-ut <delay>
10195 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10196 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10197 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10198 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10199 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10200 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10201 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10202 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10203 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10204 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10205 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10206
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010207tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010208 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010209 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10210 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10211 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10212 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10213 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10214 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10215 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010216 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10217 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10218 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010219
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010220tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10221 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10222 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10223 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10224 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10225 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10226 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10227 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10228 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10229 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10230 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10231
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010232transparent
10233 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10234 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10235 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10236 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10237 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10238 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10239 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10240 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10241 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10242 so check for support with your vendor.
10243
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010244v4v6
10245 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10246 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10247 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10248 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010249 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010250
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010251v6only
10252 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10253 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10254 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010255 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10256 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010257
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010258uid <uid>
10259 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10260 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10261 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10262 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10263 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10264
10265user <user>
10266 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10267 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10268 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10269 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10270 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10271
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010272verify [none|optional|required]
10273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10274 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10275 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10276 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10277 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010278 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10279 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10280 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10281 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010282
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200102835.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010284------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010286The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10287which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10288arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10289settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10290after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10291Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10292address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010294 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010295 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010297The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010298
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010299addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010300 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010301 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10302 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10303 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10304 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10305 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010307 Supported in default-server: No
10308
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010309agent-check
10310 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010311 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10312 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10313 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10314 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010315
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010316 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010317 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010318 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10319 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10320 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010321
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010322 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10323 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10324 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10325 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10326 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10327
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010328 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10329 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010330
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010331 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10332 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10333 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010334
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010335 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10336 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10337 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010338
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010339 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10340 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10341 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10342 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10343 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10344 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10345 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010346
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010347 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10348 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010350 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10351 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10352 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10353 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10354 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10355 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10356 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10357 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10358 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010359
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010360 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10361 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010362 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10363 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10364 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010365 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010366
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010367 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10368 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010369
10370 Supported in default-server: No
10371
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010372agent-send <string>
10373 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10374 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10375 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10376 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10377 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10378
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010379agent-inter <delay>
10380 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10381 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10382
10383 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10384 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10385 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10386 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10387 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10388 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10389 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10390 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10391 of backends use the same servers.
10392
10393 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10394
10395 Supported in default-server: Yes
10396
10397agent-port <port>
10398 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10399
10400 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10401
10402 Supported in default-server: Yes
10403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010404backup
10405 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10406 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10407 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10408 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10409 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10410 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010411
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010412 Supported in default-server: No
10413
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010414ca-file <cafile>
10415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10416 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10417 server's certificate.
10418
10419 Supported in default-server: No
10420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010421check
10422 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010423 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10424 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10425 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10426 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10427 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10428 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10429 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010430 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10431 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10432 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010434 Supported in default-server: No
10435
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010436check-send-proxy
10437 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10438 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10439 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10440 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10441 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10442 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10443 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10444
10445 Supported in default-server: No
10446
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010447check-ssl
10448 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10449 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10450 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10451 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010452 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010453 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10454 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10455 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10456 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10457
10458 Supported in default-server: No
10459
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010460ciphers <ciphers>
10461 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010462 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010463 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10464 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10465 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10466 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10467 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10468 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10469
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010470 Supported in default-server: No
10471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010472cookie <value>
10473 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10474 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10475 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10476 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10477 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10478 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10479 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010481 Supported in default-server: No
10482
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010483crl-file <crlfile>
10484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10485 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10486 to verify server's certificate.
10487
10488 Supported in default-server: No
10489
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010490crt <cert>
10491 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10492 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10493 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10494 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10495 certificate request.
10496
10497 Supported in default-server: No
10498
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010499disabled
10500 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10501 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10502 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10503 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10504 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10505
10506 Supported in default-server: No
10507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010508error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010509 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10510 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10511 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010513 Supported in default-server: Yes
10514
10515 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010517fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010518 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10519 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10520 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10521
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010522 Supported in default-server: Yes
10523
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010524force-sslv3
10525 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10526 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010527 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10528 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010529
10530 Supported in default-server: No
10531
10532force-tlsv10
10533 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010534 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10535 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010536
10537 Supported in default-server: No
10538
10539force-tlsv11
10540 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010541 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10542 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010543
10544 Supported in default-server: No
10545
10546force-tlsv12
10547 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010548 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10549 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010550
10551 Supported in default-server: No
10552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010553id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010554 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10555 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10556 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010558 Supported in default-server: No
10559
10560inter <delay>
10561fastinter <delay>
10562downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010563 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10564 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10565 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10566 between checks depending on the server state :
10567
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010568 Server state | Interval used
10569 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10570 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10571 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10572 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10573 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10574 or yet unchecked. |
10575 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10576 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10577 | "inter" otherwise.
10578 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010580 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10581 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10582 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10583 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010584 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10585 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10586 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10587 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10588 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010590 Supported in default-server: Yes
10591
10592maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010593 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10594 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10595 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10596 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10597 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10598 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10599 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10600 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10601
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010602 Supported in default-server: Yes
10603
10604maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010605 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10606 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10607 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10608 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10609 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10610 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10611 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010613 Supported in default-server: Yes
10614
10615minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010616 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10617 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10618 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10619 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10620 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10621 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010622 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010623 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010625 Supported in default-server: Yes
10626
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010627namespace <name>
10628 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10629 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10630 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10631 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10632
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010633no-ssl-reuse
10634 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10635 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10636 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10637 and for paranoid users.
10638
10639 Supported in default-server: No
10640
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010641no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010642 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10643 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010644 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010645
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010646 Supported in default-server: No
10647
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010648no-tls-tickets
10649 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10650 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10651 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010652 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10653 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010654
10655 Supported in default-server: No
10656
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010657no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010658 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010659 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10660 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010661 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10662 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10663 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010664
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010665 Supported in default-server: No
10666
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010667no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010668 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010669 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10670 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010671 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10672 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10673 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010674
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010675 Supported in default-server: No
10676
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010677no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010678 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010679 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10680 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010681 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10682 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10683 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010684
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010685 Supported in default-server: No
10686
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010687non-stick
10688 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10689 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10690 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10691
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010692 Supported in default-server: No
10693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010694observe <mode>
10695 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10696 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10697 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10698 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10699 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10700 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010701 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010703 Supported in default-server: No
10704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010705 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010707on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010708 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10709 Currently, four modes are available:
10710 - fastinter: force fastinter
10711 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10712 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10713 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10714 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010716 Supported in default-server: Yes
10717
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010718 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10719
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010720on-marked-down <action>
10721 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10722 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010723 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10724 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10725 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10726 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10727 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10728 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10729 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10730 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010731
10732 Actions are disabled by default
10733
10734 Supported in default-server: Yes
10735
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010736on-marked-up <action>
10737 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10738 Currently one action is available:
10739 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10740 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10741 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10742 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10743 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10744 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10745 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10746 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10747
10748 Actions are disabled by default
10749
10750 Supported in default-server: Yes
10751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010752port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010753 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10754 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10755 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10756 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10757 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10758 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010760 Supported in default-server: Yes
10761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010762redir <prefix>
10763 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10764 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10765 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10766 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10767 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10768 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10769 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10770 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010771 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010772 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10773 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10774 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10775 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10776 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10777
10778 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010780 Supported in default-server: No
10781
10782rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010783 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10784 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10785 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010787 Supported in default-server: Yes
10788
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010789resolve-prefer <family>
10790 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10791 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10792 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10793 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10794
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010795 Default value: ipv6
10796
10797 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010798
10799 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10800
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010801resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10802 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10803 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10804 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10805 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10806 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10807 configured network, another address is selected.
10808
10809 Supported in default-server: Yes
10810
10811 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
10812
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010813resolvers <id>
10814 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10815 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010816 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10817 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10818 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10819 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010820
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010821 Supported in default-server: No
10822
10823 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010824
10825 See also chapter 5.3
10826
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010827send-proxy
10828 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10829 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10830 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10831 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010832 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
10833 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
10834 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
10835 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
10836 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
10837 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
10838 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
10839 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
10840 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
10841 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
10842 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
10843 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010844
10845 Supported in default-server: No
10846
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010847send-proxy-v2
10848 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10849 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10850 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10851 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10852 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10853 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10854 option of the "bind" keyword.
10855
10856 Supported in default-server: No
10857
10858send-proxy-v2-ssl
10859 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10860 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10861 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10862 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10863 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10864 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10865 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10866 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10867
10868 Supported in default-server: No
10869
10870send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10871 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10872 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10873 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10874 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10875 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10876 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10877 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10878 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10879 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10880
10881 Supported in default-server: No
10882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010883slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010884 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10885 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10886 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10887 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10888 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10889 parameters :
10890
10891 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10892 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10893
10894 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10895 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10896 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10897 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10898
10899 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10900 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10901 seen as failed.
10902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010903 Supported in default-server: Yes
10904
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010905sni <expression>
10906 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10907 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10908 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10909 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10910 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10911
10912 Supported in default-server: no
10913
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010914source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010915source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010916source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010917 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10918 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10919 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10920 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10921
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010922 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10923 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10924 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10925 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10926 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10927 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10928 server.
10929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010930 Supported in default-server: No
10931
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010932ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010933 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10934 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10935 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10936 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10937 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10938 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010939 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010940
10941 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010942
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010943tcp-ut <delay>
10944 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10945 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10946 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10947 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10948 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10949 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10950 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10951 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10952 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10953 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10954 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10955 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10956 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010958track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010959 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10960 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10961 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10962 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010963 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010965 Supported in default-server: No
10966
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010967verify [none|required]
10968 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010969 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10970 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10971 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10972 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010973 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10974 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10975 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010976
10977 Supported in default-server: No
10978
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010979verifyhost <hostname>
10980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10981 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10982 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10983 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10984 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10985 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10986
10987 Supported in default-server: No
10988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010989weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010990 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10991 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10992 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010993 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10994 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10995 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10996 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10997 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10998 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011000 Supported in default-server: Yes
11001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011002
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110035.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11004-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011005
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011006HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11007using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11008configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011009This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11010can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11011workload.
11012This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11013resolution at run time.
11014Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11015carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11016
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011017Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11018health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11019
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011020
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110215.3.1. Global overview
11022----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011023
11024As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11025different steps of the process life:
11026
11027 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11028 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11029 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11030
11031 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11032 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11033 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11034
11035A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11036 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11037 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11038 resolution to know this new IP.
11039
11040A few things important to notice:
11041 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11042 first valid response.
11043
11044 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11045 servers return an error.
11046
11047
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110485.3.2. The resolvers section
11049----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011050
11051This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11052HAProxy.
11053There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11054many name servers.
11055
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011056When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11057uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11058is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11059answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11060
11061When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11062used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11063
11064Two types of behavior can be applied:
11065 1. stop DNS resolution
11066 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11067 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11068 1. ANY query type
11069 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11070 server's parameter
11071 3. remaining family type
11072
11073HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11074 - invalid DNS response packet
11075 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11076 - NX domain
11077 - Query refused by server
11078 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11079
11080HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11081 - no Answer records in the response
11082 - DNS response truncated
11083 - Error in DNS response
11084 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11085 - name server timeout
11086
11087For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11088 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11089 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11090 applied;
11091 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11092 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11093 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11094 stops resolution.
11095
11096
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011097resolvers <resolvers id>
11098 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11099
11100A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11101
11102nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11103 DNS server description:
11104 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11105 <ip> : IP address of the server
11106 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11107
11108hold <status> <period>
11109 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11110 on last resolution <status>
11111 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11112 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11113 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11114 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11115
11116 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11117
11118 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11119 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11120 the healch check.
11121
11122resolve_retries <nb>
11123 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11124 giving up.
11125 Default value: 3
11126
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011127 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11128 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11129 type.
11130
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011131timeout <event> <time>
11132 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11133 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11134 events available are:
11135 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11136 been received.
11137 Default value: 1s
11138 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11139 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11140
11141Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
11142
11143 resolvers mydns
11144 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11145 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11146 resolve_retries 3
11147 timeout retry 1s
11148 hold valid 10s
11149
11150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111516. HTTP header manipulation
11152---------------------------
11153
11154In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11155response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11156request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11157which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011158against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011159
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011160If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11161to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11162but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11163HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11164stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11165because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11166a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11167still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011169This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11170in section 4.2 :
11171
11172 - reqadd <string>
11173 - reqallow <search>
11174 - reqiallow <search>
11175 - reqdel <search>
11176 - reqidel <search>
11177 - reqdeny <search>
11178 - reqideny <search>
11179 - reqpass <search>
11180 - reqipass <search>
11181 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11182 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11183 - reqtarpit <search>
11184 - reqitarpit <search>
11185 - rspadd <string>
11186 - rspdel <search>
11187 - rspidel <search>
11188 - rspdeny <search>
11189 - rspideny <search>
11190 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11191 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11192
11193With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11194is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11195parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11196prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11197Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11198
11199 \t for a tab
11200 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11201 \n for a new line (LF)
11202 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11203 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11204 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11205 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11206 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11207
11208The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11209portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11210above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11211regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
112129 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11213is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11214
11215The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11216after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11217
11218Notes related to these keywords :
11219---------------------------------
11220 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11221 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11222 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11223
11224 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11225 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11226 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11227
11228 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11229 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11230 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11231 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11232 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11233
11234 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11235 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11236 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11237 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11238 useless headers before adding new ones.
11239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011240 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011241 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11242
11243 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11244 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11245 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11246
11247 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11248 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011249 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011250
11251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112527. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11253----------------------------------
11254
11255Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11256client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11257The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11258these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11259but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11260data called patterns.
11261
11262
112637.1. ACL basics
11264---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011265
11266The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11267content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11268from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11269simple :
11270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011271 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011272 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011273 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11274 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011276The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11277adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011278
11279In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011281 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011282
11283This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11284Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11285and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011286an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11287conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11288as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11289are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011290
11291ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11292'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11293which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11294
11295There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11296performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011298The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11299specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11300this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011301methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11302ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011303
11304Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11305 - boolean
11306 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11307 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11308 - string
11309 - data block
11310
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011311Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11312converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11313would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11314The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11315which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11316
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011317Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11318keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11319fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11320which are summarized in the table below :
11321
11322 +---------------------+-----------------+
11323 | Sample or converter | Default |
11324 | output type | matching method |
11325 +---------------------+-----------------+
11326 | boolean | bool |
11327 +---------------------+-----------------+
11328 | integer | int |
11329 +---------------------+-----------------+
11330 | ip | ip |
11331 +---------------------+-----------------+
11332 | string | str |
11333 +---------------------+-----------------+
11334 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11335 +---------------------+-----------------+
11336
11337Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11338matching method, see below.
11339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011340The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11341 - boolean
11342 - integer or integer range
11343 - IP address / network
11344 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11345 - regular expression
11346 - hex block
11347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011348The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11349
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011350 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11351 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011353 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011354 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011355 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011356 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011358The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11359read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11360if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11361lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11362will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11363beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11364a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11365lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11366exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11367
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011368The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11369parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11370ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11371a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11372check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11373
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011374The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11375socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11376file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11379loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11380
11381 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11382
11383In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11384the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11385case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11386as well.
11387
11388The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11389sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11390do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11391methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11392is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11393obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11394followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11395default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11396that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11397string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11398
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011399The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11400By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11401string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11402resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11403server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11404waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11405flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11406function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11409sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11410be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011411
11412 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11413 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11415 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11416 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11417 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011418
11419 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11420 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011421 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011422
11423 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011424 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011425
11426 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011427 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011428
11429 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11430 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11431
11432 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11433 binary or string samples.
11434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011435 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11436 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011438 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11439 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11440 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011442 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11443 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011445 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11446 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011448 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11449 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011451 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11452 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011453 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011455 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11456 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11457 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011458
11459For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11460request, it is possible to do :
11461
11462 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11463
11464In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11465buffer, one would use the following acl :
11466
11467 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11468
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011469On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11470possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11471
11472 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011474All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11475criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11476method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11477to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11478criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11479the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011482the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11483For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011485 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11486 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11487 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11488 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011489
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011490
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011491The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11492types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11493combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11494brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11495default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497 +-------------------------------------------------+
11498 | Input sample type |
11499 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011500 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011501 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11502 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11503 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011504 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011505 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011506 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011508 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011509 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011510 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011512 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011514 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011515 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011516 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011518 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011519 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011520 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011522 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011524 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11526 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011528
11529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115307.1.1. Matching booleans
11531------------------------
11532
11533In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11534Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11535When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11536that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11537
11538Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11539return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11540"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115437.1.2. Matching integers
11544------------------------
11545
11546Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11547enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11548to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11549
11550Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11551matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11552lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011553
11554For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11555unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11556representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11557
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011558As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11559two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11560instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11561ranges and operators.
11562
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011563For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011564operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11565Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11566of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011567
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011568Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011569
11570 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11571 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11572 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11573 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11574 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11575
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011576For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011577
11578 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11579
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011580This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11581
11582 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11583
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115857.1.3. Matching strings
11586-----------------------
11587
11588String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11589different forms :
11590
11591 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11592 patterns ;
11593
11594 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11595 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11596
11597 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11598 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11599
11600 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11601 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11602
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011603 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011604 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11605 matches.
11606
11607 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11608 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11609 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011610
11611String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11612exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11613characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11614string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11615to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011616before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011617
11618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116197.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11620---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011621
11622Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11623they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11624possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11625passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11626the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011627the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11628match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011629
11630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116317.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11632-------------------------------------
11633
11634It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11635not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11636a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11637to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11638digits may be used upper or lower case.
11639
11640Example :
11641 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11642 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11643
11644
116457.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11646---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011647
11648IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11649netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11650within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011651host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011652difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11653at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11654does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11655parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011656
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011657The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11658abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11659
11660 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11661 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11662 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11663 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11664 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11665 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11666 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11667 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11668
11669Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11670192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11671
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011672IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11673Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11674trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11675IPv6 patterns.
11676
11677HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11678following situations :
11679 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11680 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11681 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11682 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11683 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11684 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11685 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11686 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11687 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11688 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011690
116917.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11692----------------------------------
11693
11694Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11695combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11696
11697 - AND (implicit)
11698 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11699 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011701A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011703 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011705Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11706indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011708For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11709"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11710requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11711is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11712
11713 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11714 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11715 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11716 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11717
11718To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11719and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11720
11721 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11722 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11723 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11724 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11725
11726 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11727 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11728 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11729 use_backend www if host_www
11730
11731It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11732expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11733be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11734the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11735
11736 The following rule :
11737
11738 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11739 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11740
11741 Can also be written that way :
11742
11743 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11744
11745It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11746to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11747simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11748sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11749good use is the following :
11750
11751 With named ACLs :
11752
11753 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11754 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11755 monitor fail if site_dead
11756
11757 With anonymous ACLs :
11758
11759 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11760
11761See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11762
11763
117647.3. Fetching samples
11765---------------------
11766
11767Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11768against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11769sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11770ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11771of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11772available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11773
11774This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11775Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11776compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11777deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11778
11779The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11780matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11781method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11782indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11783
11784As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11785when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11786mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11787the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11788ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11789
11790Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11791multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11792when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11793incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11794are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11795is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11796all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11797
11798Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11799 - name
11800 - name(arg1)
11801 - name(arg1,arg2)
11802
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011803
118047.3.1. Converters
11805-----------------
11806
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011807Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11808of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11809is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11810was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11811has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11812unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11813
11814These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11815sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11816the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11817support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011818
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011819A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11820support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11821supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11822(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11823bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011825The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011826
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011827add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011828 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011829 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011830 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11831 scopes allowed are:
11832 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11833 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11834 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11835 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11836 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011837 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011838
11839and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011840 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011841 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011842 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11843 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11844 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11845 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11846 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11847 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11848 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011849 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011850
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011851base64
11852 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11853 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11854 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11855
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011856bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011857 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011858 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11859 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11860 presence of a flag).
11861
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011862bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11863 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11864 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11865 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11866
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011867cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011868 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11869 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011870
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011871crc32([<avalanche>])
11872 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11873 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11874 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11875 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11876 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11877 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11878 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11879 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11880 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11881 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11882 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11883
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011884da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011885 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11886 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11887 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11888 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011889 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011890 configuration language.
11891
11892 Example:
11893 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011894 bind *:8881
11895 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011896 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011897
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011898debug
11899 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11900 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11901 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11902
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011903div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011904 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11905 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011906 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011907 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11908 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11909 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11910 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11911 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11912 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011914 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011915
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011916djb2([<avalanche>])
11917 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11918 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11919 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11920 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11921 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11922 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11923 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011924 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11925 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011926
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011927even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011928 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011929 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11930
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011931field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11932 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11933 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11934 list of chars.
11935
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011936hex
11937 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11938 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11939 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11940 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011941
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011942http_date([<offset>])
11943 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11944 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11945 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11946 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11947 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11948 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011949
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011950in_table(<table>)
11951 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11952 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11953 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11954 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11955 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11956
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011957ipmask(<mask>)
11958 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11959 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11960 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11961 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11962
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011963json([<input-code>])
11964 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11965 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11966 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11967 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11968 of errors:
11969 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11970 bytes, ...)
11971 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11972 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11973
11974 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11975 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11976 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11977 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11978 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11979 are :
11980 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11981 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11982 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11983 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11984 error ;
11985 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11986 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11987
11988 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11989 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11990
11991 Example:
11992 capture request header user-agent len 150
11993 capture request header Host len 15
Mac Browninge83345d2016-03-14 14:46:01 -040011994 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json("utf8s")]"}
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011995
11996 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11997 GET / HTTP/1.0
11998 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11999
12000 Output log:
12001 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12002
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012003language(<value>[,<default>])
12004 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12005 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12006 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12007 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12008 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12009 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12010 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12011 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12012 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12013 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12014 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12015 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012016
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012017 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012018
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012019 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12020 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012021
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012022 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12023 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12024 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12025 use_backend spanish if es
12026 use_backend french if fr
12027 use_backend english if en
12028 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012029
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012030lower
12031 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12032 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12033 type. The result is of type string.
12034
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012035ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12036 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12037 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12038 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12039 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12040 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12041 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12042
12043 Example :
12044
12045 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12046 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12047 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012049map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12050map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12051map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12052 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12053 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12054 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12055 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12056 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12057 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12058 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12059 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012060
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012061 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12062 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12063 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012064
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012065 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12066 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012067
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012068 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12070 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012072 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012074 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12076 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12077 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12078 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12079 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12080 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12081 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012082 | | map_reg | |
12083 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12084 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012085 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12086 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12087 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12088 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12089 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012090
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012091 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12092 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12093 the corresponding match text.
12094
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012095 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12096 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12097 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12098 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12099 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012100
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012101 Example :
12102
12103 # this is a comment and is ignored
12104 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12105 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12106 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12107 | | | `---------- value
12108 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12109 | `---------------------------- key
12110 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12111
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012112mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012113 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12114 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012115 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012116 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12117 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12118 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12119 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12120 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12121 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012122 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012123
12124mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012125 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012126 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12127 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012128 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012129 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12130 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12131 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12132 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12133 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12134 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012135 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012136
12137neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012138 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12139 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12140 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12141 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012142
12143not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012144 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012145 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12146 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12147 absence of a flag).
12148
12149odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012150 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012151 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12152
12153or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012154 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012155 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012156 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12157 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12158 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12159 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12160 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12161 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12162 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012163 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012164
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012165regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012166 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12167 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12168 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12169 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12170 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12171 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12172 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12173 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12174 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12175 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012176 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12177 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12178 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12179 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012180
12181 Example :
12182
12183 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12184 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12185 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12186 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12187
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012188capture-req(<id>)
12189 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12190 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12191
12192 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012193 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12194 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012195
12196capture-res(<id>)
12197 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12198 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12199
12200 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012201 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12202 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012203
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012204sdbm([<avalanche>])
12205 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12206 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12207 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12208 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12209 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12210 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12211 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012212 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12213 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012214
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012215set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012216 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12217 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12218 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12219 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12220 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012221 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012222 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12223 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012224 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12225 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12226
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012227sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012228 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12229 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012230 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012231 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12232 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12233 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12234 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012235 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012236 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12237 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012238 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12239 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012240
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012241table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12242 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12243 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12244 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12245 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12246 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12247 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12248
12249
12250table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12251 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12252 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12253 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12254 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12255 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12256 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12257
12258table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12259 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12260 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12261 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12262 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12263 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12264
12265table_conn_cur(<table>)
12266 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12267 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12268 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12269 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12270 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12271
12272table_conn_rate(<table>)
12273 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12274 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12275 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12276 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12277 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12278
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012279table_gpt0(<table>)
12280 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12281 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12282 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12283 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12284 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12285
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012286table_gpc0(<table>)
12287 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12288 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12289 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12290 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12291 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12292
12293table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12294 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12295 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12296 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12297 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12298 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12299 sample fetch keyword.
12300
12301table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12302 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12303 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12304 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12305 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12306 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12307
12308table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12309 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12310 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12311 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12312 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12313 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12314 keyword.
12315
12316table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12317 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12318 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12319 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12320 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12321 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12322
12323table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12324 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12325 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12326 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12327 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12328 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12329 keyword.
12330
12331table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12332 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12333 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12334 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12335 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12336 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12337 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12338 keyword.
12339
12340table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12344 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12345 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12346 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12347 keyword.
12348
12349table_server_id(<table>)
12350 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12351 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12352 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12353 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12354 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12355 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12356
12357table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12358 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12359 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12360 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12361 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12362 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12363 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12364 keyword.
12365
12366table_sess_rate(<table>)
12367 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12368 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12369 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12370 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12371 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12372 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12373 keyword.
12374
12375table_trackers(<table>)
12376 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12377 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12378 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12379 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12380 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12381 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12382 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12383 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12384 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12385 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12386
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012387upper
12388 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12389 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12390 type. The result is of type string.
12391
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012392url_dec
12393 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12394 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12395
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012396utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12397 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12398 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12399 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12400 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12401 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12402 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12403
12404 Example :
12405
12406 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12407 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12408 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12409
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012410word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12411 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12412 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12413
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012414wt6([<avalanche>])
12415 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12416 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12417 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12418 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12419 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12420 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12421 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012422 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12423 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012424
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012425xor(<value>)
12426 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012427 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012428 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012429 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12430 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12431 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012432 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012433 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12434 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012435 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12436 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012437
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124397.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012440--------------------------------------------
12441
12442A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12443not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12444"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12445The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12446
12447always_false : boolean
12448 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12449 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12450
12451always_true : boolean
12452 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12453 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12454
12455avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012456 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012457 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12458 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12459 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12460 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12461 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12462 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12463 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12464 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12465 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12466 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12467 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12468 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12469 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012471be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012472 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12473 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12474 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12475 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12476 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12479 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12480 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12481 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12482 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12483 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12484 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012485
12486 Example :
12487 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12488 backend dynamic
12489 mode http
12490 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12491 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012492
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012493bin(<hexa>) : bin
12494 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12495 of the string.
12496
12497bool(<bool>) : bool
12498 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12499 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012501connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12502 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012503 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012504 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12505 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012506
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012507 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012508 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012509 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12510
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012511 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12512 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012513
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012514 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012515 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012516 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012517 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12518 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012520 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012521
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012522 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12523 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012524 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012525 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012526
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012527date([<offset>]) : integer
12528 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12529 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12530 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12531 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012532 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12533
12534 Example :
12535
12536 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12537 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012538
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012539env(<name>) : string
12540 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12541 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12542 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12543 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12544 certain way.
12545
12546 Examples :
12547 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12548 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12549
12550 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12551 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012553fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12554 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012555 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12556 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012557 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12558 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12559 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12560 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12561 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012563fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12564 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12565 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12566 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12567 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12568 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12569 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12570 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12571 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012572
12573 Example :
12574 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12575 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12576 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12577 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12578 frontend mail
12579 bind :25
12580 mode tcp
12581 maxconn 100
12582 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12583 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12584 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12585 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012586
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012587int(<integer>) : signed integer
12588 Returns a signed integer.
12589
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012590ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12591 Returns an ipv4.
12592
12593ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12594 Returns an ipv6.
12595
12596meth(<method>) : method
12597 Returns a method.
12598
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012599nbproc : integer
12600 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12601 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12602 and debugging purposes.
12603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012604nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12605 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12606 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12607 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012608 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12609 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12610 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012611
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012612proc : integer
12613 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12614 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12615 debugging purposes.
12616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012617queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012618 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12619 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12620 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012621 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12622 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12623 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12624 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12625 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12626
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012627rand([<range>]) : integer
12628 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12629 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12630 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12631 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12632 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012634srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12635 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12636 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12637 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12638 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12639 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12640 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12641 methods.
12642
12643srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12644 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12645 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12646 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12647 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12648 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12649 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12650 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12651
12652srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12653 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12654 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012655 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012656 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12657 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12658 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12659 overloading servers).
12660
12661 Example :
12662 # Redirect to a separate back
12663 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12664 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12665 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12666
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012667stopping : boolean
12668 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12669 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12670 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12671
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012672str(<string>) : string
12673 Returns a string.
12674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012675table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12676 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12677 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12678
12679table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12680 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12681 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12682 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12683
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012684var(<var-name>) : undefined
12685 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012686 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12687 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12688 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12689 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012690 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012691 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12692 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12694 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12695
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200126967.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012697----------------------------------
12698
12699The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12700closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12701methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12702sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12703TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012704the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12705counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12706"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012707argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12708the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12709this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012710
12711be_id : integer
12712 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12713 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12714
12715dst : ip
12716 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12717 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12718 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12719 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12720 RFC 4291.
12721
12722dst_conn : integer
12723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12724 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12725 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12726 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12727 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12728 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12729 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12730 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012732dst_port : integer
12733 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12734 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12735 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12736 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12737 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12738 an HTTP header.
12739
12740fe_id : integer
12741 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12742 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12743 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12744
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012745sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012746sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12747sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12748sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012749 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12750 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12751 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12752
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012753sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012754sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12755sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12756sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012757 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12758 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12759 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12760
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012761sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012762sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12763sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12764sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012765 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12766 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012767 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12768 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12769 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012770
12771 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12772 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012773 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12774 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12775 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012776 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12777 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12778
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012779sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012780sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12781sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12782sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012783 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12784 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012786sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012787sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12788sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12789sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012790 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12791 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12792 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012794sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012795sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12796sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12797sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012798 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12799 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12800 See also src_conn_rate.
12801
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012802sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012803sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12804sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12805sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012806 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012807 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012808
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012809sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12810sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12811sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12812sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12813 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12814 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12815
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012816sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012817sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12818sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12819sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012820 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12821 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12822 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012823 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12824 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12825 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012827sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012828sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12829sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12830sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012831 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12832 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12833 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012835sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012836sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12837sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12838sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012839 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12840 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12841 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12842 src_http_err_rate.
12843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012844sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012845sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12846sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12847sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012848 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12849 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12850 src_http_req_cnt.
12851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012852sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012853sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12854sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12855sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012856 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12857 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12858 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12859 src_http_req_rate.
12860
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012861sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012862sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12863sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12864sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012865 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012866 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12867 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12868 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12869 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012870
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012871 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12872 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012873 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12874
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012875sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012876sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12877sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12878sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012879 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12880 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12881 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012882
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012883sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012884sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12885sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12886sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012887 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12888 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12889 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012890
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012891sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012892sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12893sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12894sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012895 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12896 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12897 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12898 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012899 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012900 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12901
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012902sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012903sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12904sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12905sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012906 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12907 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12908 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12909 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12910 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012911 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012913sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012914sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12915sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12916sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012917 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12918 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12919 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012921sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012922sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12923sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12924sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012925 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12926 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012927 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012928 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12929 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12931 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12932 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012934so_id : integer
12935 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12936 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12937 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012939src : ip
12940 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12941 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12942 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12943 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012944 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
12945 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
12946 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
12947 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012948
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012949 Example:
12950 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12951 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012953src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12954 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12955 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12956 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012957 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012959src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12960 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12961 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012962 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012963 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012965src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12966 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12967 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12968 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12969 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12970 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12971 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012972
12973 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12974 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12975 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12976 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012977 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012978 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12979 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012981src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012982 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012983 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012984 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012985 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012987src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012988 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12990 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012991 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012993src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12994 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12995 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12996 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012997 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012999src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013000 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013001 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013002 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013003 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013004
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013005src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13006 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13007 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13008 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13009 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013011src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013012 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013014 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13015 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013016 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13017 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13018 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13021 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13022 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013023 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013024 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013025 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13028 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13029 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13030 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13031 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013032 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013034src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13035 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13036 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13037 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013038 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13041 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13042 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13043 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013044 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013045 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13048 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13049 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13050 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013051 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13053 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013054
13055 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013056 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013057 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013059src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013060 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13061 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13062 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13063 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13064 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013067 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13068 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13069 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13070 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13071 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013073src_port : integer
13074 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13075 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13076 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13077 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13080 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013081 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13082 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13083 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013084 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013086src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13087 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13088 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13089 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13090 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013091 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013093src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13094 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13095 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13096 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13097 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13098 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13099 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13100 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13101 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013102
13103 Example :
13104 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13105 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13106 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13107 listen ssh
13108 bind :22
13109 mode tcp
13110 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013111 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013113 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013115srv_id : integer
13116 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13117 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13118 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013119
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010013120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131217.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013122----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13125closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13126when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13127usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013128future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013129
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013130ssl_bc : boolean
13131 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13132 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13133 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13134
13135ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13136 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13137 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13138
13139ssl_bc_cipher : string
13140 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13141 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13142
13143ssl_bc_protocol : string
13144 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13145 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13146
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013147ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013148 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013149 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13150 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013151
13152ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13153 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13154 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13155 if session was reused or not.
13156
13157ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13158 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13159 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13162 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13163 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13164 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13165 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13166 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13169 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13170 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13171 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13172 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013173
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013174ssl_c_der : binary
13175 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13176 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13177 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013179ssl_c_err : integer
13180 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13181 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13182 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13183 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13184 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013186ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13187 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13188 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13189 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13190 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13191 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13192 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13193 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13194 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013196ssl_c_key_alg : string
13197 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13198 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13199 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013201ssl_c_notafter : string
13202 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13203 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13204 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206ssl_c_notbefore : string
13207 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13208 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13209 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013211ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13212 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13213 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13214 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13215 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13216 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13217 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13218 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13219 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221ssl_c_serial : binary
13222 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13223 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13224 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013226ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13227 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13228 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13229 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013230 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13231 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13232
13233 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013235ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13236 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13237 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13238 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013240ssl_c_used : boolean
13241 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13242 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013244ssl_c_verify : integer
13245 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13246 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13247 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13248 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250ssl_c_version : integer
13251 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13252 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013253
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013254ssl_f_der : binary
13255 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13256 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13257 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013259ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13260 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13261 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13262 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13263 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013264 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013265 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13266 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13267 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269ssl_f_key_alg : string
13270 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13271 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13272 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013274ssl_f_notafter : string
13275 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13276 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13277 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279ssl_f_notbefore : string
13280 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13281 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13282 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13285 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13286 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13287 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13288 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13289 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13290 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13291 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13292 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013294ssl_f_serial : binary
13295 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13296 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13297 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013298
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013299ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13300 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13301 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13302 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13305 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13306 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13307 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013309ssl_f_version : integer
13310 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13311 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13312
13313ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013314 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13315 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13316 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013318 Example :
13319 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13320 listen http-https
13321 bind :80
13322 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13323 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13324
13325ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13326 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13327 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13328
13329ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013330 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13332 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13333 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13334 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13335 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13336 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13337 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13338 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340ssl_fc_cipher : string
13341 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13342 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013345 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13346 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013347 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13348 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13349 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13350 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013352ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13353 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013354 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13355 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13356 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13357 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013358
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013359ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013360 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13361 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013363ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013364 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013365 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13366 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13367 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13368 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13369 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13370 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13371 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013373ssl_fc_protocol : string
13374 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13375 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013376
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013377ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013378 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013379 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13380 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013382ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13383 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13384 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13385 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13386 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013388ssl_fc_sni : string
13389 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13390 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13391 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13392 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13393 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13394
13395 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13396 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13397 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013398 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13399 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013401 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013402 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13403 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13406 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13407 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013408
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013409
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134107.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13414sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13415only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13416For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13417be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13418can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13419sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13420for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13421content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13424 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13425 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13426 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13429 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13430 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13431 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433req.len : integer
13434req_len : integer (deprecated)
13435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13436 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13437 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13438 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13439 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13440 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13441 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13442 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013444req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13445 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013446 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13447 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13448 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13449 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451 ACL alternatives :
13452 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013454req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13455 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13456 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13457 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13458 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013460 ACL alternatives :
13461 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013465req.proto_http : boolean
13466req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13467 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13468 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13469 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13470 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13471 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13472 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13473 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013475 Example:
13476 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13477 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13478 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013479 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013481req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13482rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13483 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13484 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13485 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13486 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13487 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13488 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13489 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13492 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13493 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13494 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13495 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13496 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498 ACL derivatives :
13499 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501 Example :
13502 listen tse-farm
13503 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13504 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13505 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13506 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13507 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13508 persist rdp-cookie
13509 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13510 # This is only useful makes sense if
13511 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13512 stick-table type string size 204800
13513 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13514 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13515 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013517 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13518 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013520req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13521rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13522 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13523 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13524 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13525 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013527 ACL derivatives :
13528 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013529
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013530req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13531 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13532 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013533 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13534 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13535 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13536 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13537 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013539req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13540req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13541 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13542 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13543 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13544 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13545 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13546 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13547 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013549req.ssl_sni : string
13550req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13551 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13552 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13553 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13554 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13555 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13556 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13557 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13558 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13559 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13560 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13561 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13562 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013564 ACL derivatives :
13565 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013567 Examples :
13568 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13569 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13570 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13571 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13572 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013573
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013574req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13575 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13576 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13577 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13578 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13579 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13580 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13581 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13582 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13583 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013585req.ssl_ver : integer
13586req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13587 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13588 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13589 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13590 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13591 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13592 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13593 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13594 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13595 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013597 ACL derivatives :
13598 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013599
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013600res.len : integer
13601 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13602 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13603 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13604 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13605 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13606 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13607 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13608 content inspection.
13609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013610res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13611 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013612 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13613 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13614 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13615 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013617res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13618 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13619 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13620 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13621 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013624
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013625res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13626rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13627 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13628 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13629 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13630 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13631 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13632 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13633 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635wait_end : boolean
13636 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13637 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13638 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13639 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13640 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13641 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13642 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13643 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645 Examples :
13646 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13647 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13648 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13651 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13652 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13653 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13654 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13655 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13656 tcp-request content reject
13657
13658
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136597.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013660--------------------------------------
13661
13662It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13663This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13664data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13665its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13666HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13667content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13668to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13669more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13670response are indexed.
13671
13672base : string
13673 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13674 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13675 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13676 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13677 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13678 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13679 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13680 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13681
13682 ACL derivatives :
13683 base : exact string match
13684 base_beg : prefix match
13685 base_dir : subdir match
13686 base_dom : domain match
13687 base_end : suffix match
13688 base_len : length match
13689 base_reg : regex match
13690 base_sub : substring match
13691
13692base32 : integer
13693 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13694 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13695 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013696 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13697 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13698 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013699
13700base32+src : binary
13701 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13702 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13703 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13704 per-URL counters.
13705
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013706capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13707 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13708 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13709 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13710
13711capture.req.method : string
13712 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13713 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13714 because it's allocated.
13715
13716capture.req.uri : string
13717 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13718 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13719 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13720 allocated.
13721
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013722capture.req.ver : string
13723 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13724 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13725 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13726
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013727capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13728 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13729 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13730 The first entry is an index of 0.
13731 See also: "capture response header"
13732
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013733capture.res.ver : string
13734 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13735 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13736 persistent flag.
13737
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013738req.body : binary
13739 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13740 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13741 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13742 the first chunk is analyzed.
13743
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013744req.body_param([<name>) : string
13745 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13746 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13747 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13748 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13749 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13750 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13751 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13752 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13753 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13754 given.
13755
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013756req.body_len : integer
13757 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13758 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13759 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13760 "option http-buffer-request".
13761
13762req.body_size : integer
13763 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13764 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13765 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13766 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13767 "option http-buffer-request".
13768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013769req.cook([<name>]) : string
13770cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13771 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13772 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13773 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13774 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13775 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13776 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13777 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13778 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13779
13780 ACL derivatives :
13781 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13782 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13783 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13784 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13785 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13786 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13787 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13788 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13791cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13792 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13793 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013795req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13796cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13797 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13798 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13799 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13800 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013802cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13803 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13804 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13805 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13806 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013807 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13809 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13810 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13811 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013813hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13814 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13815 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13816 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13817 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013818 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013820req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13821 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13822 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13823 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13824 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13825 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13826 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13827 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13828 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13831 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13832 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13833 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13834 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013836req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13837 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13838 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13839 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13840 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13841 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13842 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13843 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13844 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13845 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13846 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13847 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849 ACL derivatives :
13850 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13851 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13852 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13853 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13854 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13855 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13856 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13857 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13858
13859req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13860hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13861 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13862 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13863 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13864 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13865 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13866 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13867 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13868 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13869 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13870
13871req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13872hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13873 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13874 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13875 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13876 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13877 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13878 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13879 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13880 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13881
13882req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13883hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13884 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13885 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13886 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13887 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13888 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13889 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13890 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13891
13892http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13893 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13894 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13895 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13896 basic auth is supported.
13897
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013898http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13899 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13900 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13901 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13902 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13904 basic auth is supported.
13905
13906 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013907 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13908 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13909 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13910 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013911
13912http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013913 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13914 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013915 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13916 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013918method : integer + string
13919 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13920 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13921 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13922 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13923 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13924 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13925 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013927 ACL derivatives :
13928 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013930 Example :
13931 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13932 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13933 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935path : string
13936 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13937 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13938 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13939 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13940 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13941 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13942 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013944 ACL derivatives :
13945 path : exact string match
13946 path_beg : prefix match
13947 path_dir : subdir match
13948 path_dom : domain match
13949 path_end : suffix match
13950 path_len : length match
13951 path_reg : regex match
13952 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013953
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013954query : string
13955 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13956 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13957 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13958 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13959 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13960 which stops before the question mark.
13961
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013962req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13963 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13964 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13965 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13966 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968req.ver : string
13969req_ver : string (deprecated)
13970 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13971 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13972 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974 ACL derivatives :
13975 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013977res.comp : boolean
13978 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13979 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13980 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013982res.comp_algo : string
13983 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13984 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13985 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013987res.cook([<name>]) : string
13988scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13989 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13990 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13991 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993 ACL derivatives :
13994 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013996res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13997scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13998 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13999 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14000 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014002res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14003scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14004 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14005 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14006 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014008res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14009 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14010 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14011 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14012 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14013 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14014 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14015 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14016 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14017 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14020 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14021 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14022 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14023 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14024 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14027shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14028 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14029 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14030 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14031 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14032 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14033 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14034 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14035 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037 ACL derivatives :
14038 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14039 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14040 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14041 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14042 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14043 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14044 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14045 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14046
14047res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14048shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14049 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14050 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14051 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14052 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14053 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014055res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14056shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14057 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14058 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14059 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14060 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14061 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14062 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014063
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014064res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14065 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14066 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14067 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14068 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014070res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14071shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14072 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14073 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14074 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14075 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14076 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14077 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014079res.ver : string
14080resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14081 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14082 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084 ACL derivatives :
14085 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14088 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14089 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014090 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014091 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014093 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14094 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014096status : integer
14097 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14098 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14099 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014100
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014101unique-id : string
14102 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14103 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14104 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14105 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14106 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14107 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109url : string
14110 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14111 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14112 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14113 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14114 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14115 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14116 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118 ACL derivatives :
14119 url : exact string match
14120 url_beg : prefix match
14121 url_dir : subdir match
14122 url_dom : domain match
14123 url_end : suffix match
14124 url_len : length match
14125 url_reg : regex match
14126 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014128url_ip : ip
14129 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14130 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14131 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14132 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14133 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14134 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14135 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137url_port : integer
14138 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14139 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14140 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14141 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014142
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014143urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14144url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14146 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014147 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14148 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14149 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14150 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14152 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014153 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14154 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156 ACL derivatives :
14157 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14158 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14159 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14160 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14161 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14162 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14163 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14164 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014165
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167 Example :
14168 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14169 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14170 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14171 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014172
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014173urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14175 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14176 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014177
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014178url32 : integer
14179 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14180 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14181 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14182 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14183 is an unsigned integer.
14184
14185url32+src : binary
14186 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14187 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14188 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14189
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200141917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014192---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014194Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14195every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014196order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014198ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14199---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014200FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014201HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014202HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14203HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014204HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14205HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14206HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14207HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14208LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014209METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014210METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014211METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14212METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14213METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14214METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014215METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014216METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014217RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014218REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014219TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014220WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14221---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014222
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142248. Logging
14225----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014226
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014227One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14228provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14229very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14230provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14231state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014232to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014233headers.
14234
14235In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14236about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14237send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14238
14239 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14240 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14241 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14242 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14243 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014244 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14245 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014246
14247The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14248allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14249as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14250while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14251real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14252delay.
14253
14254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142558.1. Log levels
14256---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014257
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014258TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014259source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014260HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14261in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14262track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14263syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14264about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014265
14266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142678.2. Log formats
14268----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014269
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014270HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014271and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14272slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14273options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014274
14275 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14276 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14277 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14278 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14279 extents.
14280
14281 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14282 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14283 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14284 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14285 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14286
14287 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14288 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14289 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14290 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14291 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14292
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014293 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14294 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14295 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14296 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14297
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014298 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14299
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014300Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14301specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14302field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14303servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14304always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14305identifier.
14306
14307Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14308 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14309 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14310 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14311 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14312
14313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143148.2.1. Default log format
14315-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014316
14317This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14318as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14319format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14320
14321 Example :
14322 listen www
14323 mode http
14324 log global
14325 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14326
14327 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14328 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14329 (www/HTTP)
14330
14331 Field Format Extract from the example above
14332 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14333 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14334 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14335 4 'to' to
14336 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14337 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14338
14339Detailed fields description :
14340 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14341 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14342 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14343 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14344 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14345 and processed the connection.
14346 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14347
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014348In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14349"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14350connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14351
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014352It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14353will eventually disappear.
14354
14355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143568.2.2. TCP log format
14357---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014358
14359The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14360is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14361information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14362counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14363emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14364environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14365the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14366sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014367specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14368not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14369fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14370marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014371
14372 Example :
14373 frontend fnt
14374 mode tcp
14375 option tcplog
14376 log global
14377 default_backend bck
14378
14379 backend bck
14380 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14381
14382 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14383 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14384 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14385
14386 Field Format Extract from the example above
14387 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14388 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14389 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14390 4 frontend_name fnt
14391 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14392 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14393 7 bytes_read* 212
14394 8 termination_state --
14395 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14396 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14397
14398Detailed fields description :
14399 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014400 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14401 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14402 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014403 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14404 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14405 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014406
14407 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014408 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14409 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14410 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014411
14412 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14413 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14414 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14415 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14416
14417 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14418 and processed the connection.
14419
14420 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14421 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14422 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14423 applications.
14424
14425 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14426 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14427 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14428 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14429 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14430
14431 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14432 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14433 See "Timers" below for more details.
14434
14435 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14436 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14437 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14438 "Timers" below for more details.
14439
14440 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014441 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014442 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14443 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14444 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14445 details.
14446
14447 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14448 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14449 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14450 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14451 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14452
14453 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14454 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14455 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14456 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14457 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14458 for more details.
14459
14460 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014461 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014462 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14463 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14464 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014465 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014466
14467 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14468 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14469 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14470 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14471 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14472 caused by a denial of service attack.
14473
14474 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14475 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14476 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14477 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14478 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14479 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14480 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14481 denial of service attack.
14482
14483 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14484 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14485 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14486 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14487 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14488 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14489 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14490 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14491 be processed than on other servers.
14492
14493 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14494 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14495 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14496 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14497 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14498 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14499 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14500 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14501 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14502 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14503 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14504 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14505 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14506
14507 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14508 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14509 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14510 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14511 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14512 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14513 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14514 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14515
14516 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14517 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14518 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14519 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14520 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14521 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14522 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14523 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14524 occurs.
14525
14526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145278.2.3. HTTP log format
14528----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014529
14530The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14531is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14532the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14533are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14534emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14535generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14536"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14537which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014538frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14539is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014540
14541Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14542slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14543with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14544
14545 Example :
14546 frontend http-in
14547 mode http
14548 option httplog
14549 log global
14550 default_backend bck
14551
14552 backend static
14553 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14554
14555 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14556 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14557 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014558 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014559
14560 Field Format Extract from the example above
14561 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14562 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14563 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14564 4 frontend_name http-in
14565 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14566 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14567 7 status_code 200
14568 8 bytes_read* 2750
14569 9 captured_request_cookie -
14570 10 captured_response_cookie -
14571 11 termination_state ----
14572 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14573 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14574 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14575 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14576 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014577
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014578
14579Detailed fields description :
14580 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014581 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14582 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14583 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014584 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14585 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14586 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014587
14588 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014589 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14590 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14591 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014592
14593 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14594 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14595 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14596 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14597 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14598
14599 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14600 and processed the connection.
14601
14602 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14603 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14604 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14605
14606 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14607 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14608 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14609 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14610 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14611 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14612
14613 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14614 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14615 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14616 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14617 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14618 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14619
14620 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14621 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14622 See "Timers" below for more details.
14623
14624 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14625 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14626 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14627 below for more details.
14628
14629 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14630 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14631 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14632 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14633 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14634 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14635 for more details.
14636
14637 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014638 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014639 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14640 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14641 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14642 details.
14643
14644 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14645 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14646 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14647
14648 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14649 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14650 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14651 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14652 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14653 overflowing.
14654
14655 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14656 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14657 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14658 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14659 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14660 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14661 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14662 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14663
14664 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14665 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14666 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14667 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14668 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14669 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14670 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14671 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14672
14673 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14674 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14675 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14676 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14677 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14678 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14679 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14680
14681 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014682 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014683 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14684 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14685 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014686 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014687 system.
14688
14689 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14690 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14691 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14692 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14693 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14694 caused by a denial of service attack.
14695
14696 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14697 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14698 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14699 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14700 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14701 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14702 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14703 denial of service attack.
14704
14705 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14706 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14707 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14708 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14709 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14710 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14711 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14712 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14713 processed than on other servers.
14714
14715 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14716 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14717 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14718 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14719 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14720 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14721 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14722 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14723 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14724 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14725 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14726 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14727 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14728
14729 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14730 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14731 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14732 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14733 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14734 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14735 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14736 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14737
14738 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14739 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14740 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14741 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14742 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14743 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14744 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14745 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14746 occurs.
14747
14748 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14749 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14750 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14751 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14752 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14753 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14754 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14755 cookies" below for more details.
14756
14757 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14758 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14759 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14760 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14761 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14762 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14763 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14764 and cookies" below for more details.
14765
14766 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14767 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14768 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14769 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14770 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14771 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14772 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14773 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14774
14775
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200147768.2.4. Custom log format
14777------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014778
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014779The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014780mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014781
14782HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14783Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14784separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14785prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14786
14787Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14788variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014789("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014790
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014791If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014792as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014793less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14794the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14795
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014796Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014797In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014798in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014799
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014800Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14801'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14802https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14803such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14804
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014805Flags are :
14806 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014807 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014808 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14809 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014810
14811 Example:
14812
14813 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14814 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14815
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014816 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14817
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014818At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14819
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014820 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14821 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014822
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014823the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014824
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014825 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014826 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014827 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014828
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014829and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14830
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014831 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014832 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14833
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014834Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14835
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014836 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014837 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014838 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14839 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14840 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014841 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14842 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14843 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014844 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014845 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14846 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014847 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014848 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14849 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014850 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014851 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014852 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014853 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020014854 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014855 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014856 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14857 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014858 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014859 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14860 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014861 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014862 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14863 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014864 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14865 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14866 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014867 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014868 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14869 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014870 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014871 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14872 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14873 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014874 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014875 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014876 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14877 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14878 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14879 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014880 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014881 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014882 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014883 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014884 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014885 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014886 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14887 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14888 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014889 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014890 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14891 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014892 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014893 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014894 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014895 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014896
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014897 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014898
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014899
149008.2.5. Error log format
14901-----------------------
14902
14903When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14904protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14905By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14906"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14907will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14908logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14909
14910The format looks like this :
14911
14912 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14913 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14914 Connection error during SSL handshake
14915
14916 Field Format Extract from the example above
14917 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14918 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14919 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14920 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14921 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14922
14923These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14924failures.
14925
14926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149278.3. Advanced logging options
14928-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014929
14930Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14931just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14932options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14933for more information about their usage.
14934
14935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149368.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14937------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014938
14939It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14940haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14941commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14942monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14943ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14944
14945 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14946 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14947 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14948 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14949
14950 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14951 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14952 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014953 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014954 such as other load-balancers.
14955
14956 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14957 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14958 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14959
14960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149618.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14962----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014963
14964The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14965what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14966or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14967"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14968just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14969log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14970after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14971is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14972with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14973with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14974
14975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149768.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14977------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014978
14979Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14980for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14981"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14982retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14983raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14984a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14985file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14986you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14987"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14988
14989
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149908.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14991--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014992
14993Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14994multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14995them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14996"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14997logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14998error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14999and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15000too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15001useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15002alternative.
15003
15004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150058.4. Timing events
15006------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015007
15008Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15009reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15010the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15011frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
15012mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
15013
15014 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15015 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
15016 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
15017 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
15018 the client closes prematurely or times out.
15019
15020 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15021 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15022 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15023 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15024 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15025
15026 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15027 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15028 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15029 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15030 connection never established.
15031
15032 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15033 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15034 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15035 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15036 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15037 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15038 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15039 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15040 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15041 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15042 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15043
15044 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15045 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
15046 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
15047 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015048 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015049
15050 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15051
15052 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
15053 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
15054 negative.
15055
15056These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15057protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15058that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015059due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015060close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
15061session has been aborted on timeout.
15062
15063Most common cases :
15064
15065 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15066 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
15067 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
15068 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
15069 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
15070 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
15071 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
15072 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
15073 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010015074 connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive modes
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015075 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
15076 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015077
15078 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15079 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15080 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15081 of ms on remote networks.
15082
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015083 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15084 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15085 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015086
15087 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15088 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
15089 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
15090 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
15091 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
15092 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
15093 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
15094 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
15095 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
15096 to the server until another one is released.
15097
15098Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15099
15100 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
15101 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
15102 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
15103
15104 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
15105 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15106 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15107
15108 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
15109 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15110 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15111 flags.
15112
15113 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15114 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
15115 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15116 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15117 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15118 the client connection was maintained open.
15119
15120 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015121 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015122 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
15123 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15124
15125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151268.5. Session state at disconnection
15127-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015128
15129TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15130"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
151312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15132each of which has a special meaning :
15133
15134 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15135 session to terminate :
15136
15137 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15138
15139 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15140 server explicitly refused it.
15141
15142 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15143 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15144 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15145 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015146 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15147
15148 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15149 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015150
15151 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15152 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15153 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15154 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15155 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15156
15157 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15158 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15159 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15160 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15161 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15162
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015163 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15164 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15165
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015166 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15167 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15168 backup connections when going up.
15169
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015170 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015172 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15173 send or receive data.
15174
15175 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15176 send or receive data.
15177
15178 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15179 with nothing left in the buffers.
15180
15181 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15182
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015183 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015184 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15185
15186 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15187 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15188 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15189 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15190 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15191
15192 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15193 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15194
15195 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15196 server (HTTP only).
15197
15198 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15199
15200 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15201 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15202 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15203
15204 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15205 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15206 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15207
15208 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15209
15210 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15211 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15212
15213 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15214 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15215 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15216
15217 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15218 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015219 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15220 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015221
15222 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15223 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15224 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15225 another server.
15226
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015227 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015228 server.
15229
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015230 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15231 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15232 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15233 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15234
15235 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15236 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15237 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15238 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15239
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015240 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15241 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15242 "use-server" rule).
15243
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015244 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15245
15246 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15247 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15248
15249 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15250
15251 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15252 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15253 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15254
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015255 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15256 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015257 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015258 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15259 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15260
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015261 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15262
15263 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15264 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15265
15266 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15267
15268 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15269
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015270The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15271was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015272helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15273starvation, attacks, etc...
15274
15275The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15276alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15277easier finding and understanding.
15278
15279 Flags Reason
15280
15281 -- Normal termination.
15282
15283 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15284 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15285 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15286 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15287
15288 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15289 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15290 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15291 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15292 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15293 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015294
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015295 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15296 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015297 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015298
15299 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15300 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15301 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15302
15303 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15304 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15305 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15306 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15307 the server takes too long to respond.
15308
15309 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15310 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15311 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15312 long a time to respond.
15313
15314 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15315 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15316 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15317 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015318 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15319 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015320
15321 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15322 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15323 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15324 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15325 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015326 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015327 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15328 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15329 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15330 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15331 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15332 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15333 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15334 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15335 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15336 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15337 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15338 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015339
15340 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15341 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015342 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15343 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15344 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15345 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015346
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015347 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15348 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015350 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015351 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15352 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15353 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15354 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15355 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15356
15357 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15358 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15359 503 or 504 here.
15360
15361 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15362 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15363 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15364 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15365 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15366
15367 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15368 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015369 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015370 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15371 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15372
15373 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15374 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15375 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15376 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15377 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15378 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15379 between haproxy and the server.
15380
15381 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15382 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15383 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15384 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15385 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15386 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15387 solution is to fix the application.
15388
15389 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15390 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15391 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15392 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15393 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15394 external attacks.
15395
15396 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15397 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015398 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015399 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15400 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15401
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015402 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15403 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15404 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015405 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15406 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015407
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015408 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15409 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15410 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15411 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015412 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15413 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15414 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15415 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15416 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015417
15418 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15419 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15420 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15421 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15422
15423 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15424 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15425 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15426 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15427
15428 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15429 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15430 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15431 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15432
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015433The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15434persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15435important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15436re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15437
15438 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15439
15440 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15441 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15442 set on a GET request.
15443
15444 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15445 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015446 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015447 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15448
15449 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15450 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15451 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15452
15453 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15454 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15455 already got a cookie.
15456
15457 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15458 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15459 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15460 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15461 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15462
15463 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15464 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15465 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15466
15467 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15468 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15469 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15470
15471 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15472 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15473
15474 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15475 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15476 then advertised in the response.
15477
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154798.6. Non-printable characters
15480-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015481
15482In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15483consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15484converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15485prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15486being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15487escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15488is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15489'}' when logging headers.
15490
15491Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15492issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15493containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15494
15495Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15496the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15497performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15498
15499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155008.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15501---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015502
15503Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15504achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015505section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015506cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15507the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15508the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015509locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015510not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15511user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15512a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15513wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15514
15515 Examples :
15516 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15517 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15518
15519 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15520 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15521
15522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155238.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15524---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015525
15526Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15527proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15528the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15529server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15530
15531Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15532response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015533section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015534
15535It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015536time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15537appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015538are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15539and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15540follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15541request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15542in the logs.
15543
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015544As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15545frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15546an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15547
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015548 Example :
15549 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15550 listen proxy-out
15551 mode http
15552 option httplog
15553 option logasap
15554 log global
15555 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15556
15557 # log the name of the virtual server
15558 capture request header Host len 20
15559
15560 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15561 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15562
15563 # log the beginning of the referrer
15564 capture request header Referer len 20
15565
15566 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15567 capture response header Server len 20
15568
15569 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15570 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15571
15572 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15573 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15574
15575 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15576 capture response header Via len 20
15577
15578 # log the URL location during a redirection
15579 capture response header Location len 20
15580
15581 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15582 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15583 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15584 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15585 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15586
15587 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15588 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15589 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15590 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015591 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015592
15593 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15594 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15595 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15596 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15597 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015598 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015599
15600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156018.9. Examples of logs
15602---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015603
15604These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15605them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15606reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15607
15608 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15609 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15610 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15611
15612 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15613 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15614
15615 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15616 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15617 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15618
15619 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15620 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15621
15622 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15623 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15624 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15625
15626 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015627 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015628 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15629 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15630
15631 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15632 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15633 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15634
15635 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15636 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015637 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015638 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15639 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15640 to return the 502 and not the server.
15641
15642 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015643 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015644
15645 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15646 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15647 Nothing was sent to any server.
15648
15649 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15650 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15651
15652 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15653 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15654 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15655 send a 408 return code to the client.
15656
15657 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15658 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15659
15660 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15661 5 seconds ("c----").
15662
15663 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15664 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015665 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015666
15667 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015668 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015669 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15670 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15671 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15672 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15673 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015674
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015675
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200156769. Supported filters
15677--------------------
15678
15679Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15680accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15681unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15682
15683See also : "filter"
15684
156859.1. Trace
15686----------
15687
15688filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15689
15690 Arguments:
15691 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15692 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15693
15694 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15695 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15696 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15697 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15698
15699 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15700 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15701 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15702 amount of the parsed data.
15703
15704This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15705callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15706information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15707filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15708
15709Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15710tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15711a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15712
15713
157149.2. HTTP compression
15715---------------------
15716
15717filter compression
15718
15719The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15720keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15721when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15722use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15723used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15724filters evaluation order.
15725
15726See also : "compression"
15727
15728
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015729/*
15730 * Local variables:
15731 * fill-column: 79
15732 * End:
15733 */